blob: 5477766afc58ccaa3b230aa3f11cea0c04297ab2 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaua8d8d6e2017-11-03 23:52:47 +01007 2017/11/03
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000271 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200545 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200546 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100548 - presetenv
549 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550 - uid
551 - ulimit-n
552 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100553 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200554 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200555 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
556 - ssl-default-bind-options
557 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
558 - ssl-default-server-options
559 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100560 - ssl-server-verify
Christopher Faulet62519022017-10-16 15:49:32 +0200561 - thread-map
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100562 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100563 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100564 - 51degrees-data-file
565 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200566 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200567 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100568 - wurfl-data-file
569 - wurfl-information-list
570 - wurfl-information-list-separator
571 - wurfl-engine-mode
572 - wurfl-cache-size
573 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100574
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200576 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200578 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100579 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100580 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100581 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200582 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200583 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200584 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - noepoll
587 - nokqueue
588 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100589 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300590 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000591 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200592 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200593 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200594 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000595 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000596 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200597 - tune.buffers.limit
598 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200599 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200600 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100601 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200602 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200603 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200604 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100605 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200606 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200607 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100608 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100609 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100610 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100611 - tune.lua.session-timeout
612 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200613 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100614 - tune.maxaccept
615 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200616 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200617 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200618 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100619 - tune.rcvbuf.client
620 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100621 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100622 - tune.sndbuf.client
623 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100624 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100625 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200626 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100627 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200628 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200629 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100630 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200631 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100632 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200633 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
634 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
635 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100636 - tune.zlib.memlevel
637 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100638
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639 * Debugging
640 - debug
641 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642
643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006443.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645------------------------------------
646
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200647ca-base <dir>
648 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200649 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
650 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200651
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200652chroot <jail dir>
653 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
654 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
655 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
656 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
657 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
658 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100659
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100660cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
661 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
662 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
663 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100664 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
665 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
666 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
667 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
668 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
669 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
670 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
671 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
672 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
673 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100674
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200675crt-base <dir>
676 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
677 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
678 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
679
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200680daemon
681 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
682 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
683 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
684
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200685deviceatlas-json-file <path>
686 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
687 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
688
689deviceatlas-log-level <value>
690 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
691 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
692
693deviceatlas-separator <char>
694 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
695 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
696
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100697deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200698 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
699 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
700 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100701
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900702external-check
703 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
704 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
705 See "option external-check".
706
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200707gid <number>
708 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
709 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
710 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100711 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
712 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100714
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100715hard-stop-after <time>
716 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
717
718 Arguments :
719 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
720 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
721 SIGUSR1 signal.
722
723 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
724 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
725 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
726
727 Example:
728 global
729 hard-stop-after 30s
730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731group <group name>
732 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
733 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100734
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200735log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200736 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
737 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100738 configured with "log global".
739
740 <address> can be one of:
741
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100742 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100743 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
744 port).
745
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100746 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
747 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
748 port).
749
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100750 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
751 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
752 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
753 writeable).
754
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200755 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
756 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100757
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200758 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
759 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
760 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
761 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
762 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
763 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
764 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
765 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
766 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
767 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200768 JSON-formated logs may require larger values. You may also need to
769 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request uris are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200770
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200771 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
772 one of the following :
773
774 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
775 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
776
777 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
778 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
779
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100780 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200781
782 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
783 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
784 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
785
786 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200787 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
788 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
789 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
790 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
791 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
792 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200793
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200794 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200795
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100796log-send-hostname [<string>]
797 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
798 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
799 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
800 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
801 the logs.
802
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000803log-tag <string>
804 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
805 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
806 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100807 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000808
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100809lua-load <file>
810 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
811 used multiple times.
812
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200813master-worker [exit-on-failure]
814 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
815 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
816 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
817 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
818 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
819 systemd.
820 The "exit-on-failure" option allows the master to kill every workers and
821 exit when one of the current workers died. It is convenient to combine this
822 option with Restart=on-failure in a systemd unit file in order to relaunch
823 the whole process.
824
825 See alors "-W" in the management guide.
826
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200827nbproc <number>
828 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
829 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
830 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
831 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
832 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
833
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200834nbthread <number>
835 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
836 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
837 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
838 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
839 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
840
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200841pidfile <pidfile>
842 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
843 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
844 starting the process. See also "daemon".
845
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100846presetenv <name> <value>
847 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
848 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
849 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
850 and "unsetenv".
851
852resetenv [<name> ...]
853 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
854 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
855 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
856 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
857 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
858 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
859 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
860 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
861
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100862stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200863 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
864 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
865 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
866 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
867 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
868 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100869 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200870 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
871 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200872
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200873server-state-base <directory>
874 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200875 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
876 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200877
878server-state-file <file>
879 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
880 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
881 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
882 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
883 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
884 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
885 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
886 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200887 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
888 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200889
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100890setenv <name> <value>
891 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
892 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
893 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
894 and "unsetenv".
895
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100896ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
897 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
898 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300899 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100900 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
901 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
902 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
903 "bind" keyword for more information.
904
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100905ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
906 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
907 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
908 keyword to see available options.
909
910 Example:
911 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +0200912 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100913
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100914ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
915 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
916 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300917 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100918 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
919 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
920 information.
921
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100922ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
924 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
925 keyword to see available options.
926
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200927ssl-dh-param-file <file>
928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
929 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
930 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
931 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
932 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200933 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
934 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
935 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
936 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200937 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
938 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
939 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
940
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100941ssl-server-verify [none|required]
942 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
943 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
944 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
945
Christopher Faulet62519022017-10-16 15:49:32 +0200946
947thread-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <"all"|"odd"|"even"|thread_num> <cpu-set>...
948 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
949 binds a thread to a specific CPU set. The process must be specified to allow
950 different mapping for different processes. For details about the arguments,
951 see "cpu-map" directive. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its
952 mapping and the one of the process on which it is attached. If the
953 intersection is null, no specific bind will be set for the thread.
954
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200955stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
956 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
957 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
958 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +0200959 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200960 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200961
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200962 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
963 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
964 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200965
966stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
967 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
968 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100969 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200970
971stats maxconn <connections>
972 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
973 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
974
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200975uid <number>
976 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
977 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
978 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
979 one. See also "gid" and "user".
980
981ulimit-n <number>
982 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
983 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
984 option.
985
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100986unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
987 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
988
989 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
990 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
991 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
992 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
993 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
994 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
995 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
996 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
997 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
998 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
999
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001000unsetenv [<name> ...]
1001 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1002 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1003 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1004 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1005 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1006 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1007 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1008
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001009user <user name>
1010 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1011 See also "uid" and "group".
1012
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001013node <name>
1014 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1015
1016 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1017 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1018 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1019 traffic.
1020
1021description <text>
1022 Add a text that describes the instance.
1023
1024 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1025 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1026 "<" and ">" characters.
1027
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100102851degrees-data-file <file path>
1029 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1030 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
1031
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001032 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001033 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1034
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000103551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001036 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1037 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1038 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1039
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001040 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001041 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1042
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200104351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001044 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1045 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1046
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001047 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1048 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1049
105051degrees-cache-size <number>
1051 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1052 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1053 By default, this cache is disabled.
1054
1055 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001056 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1057
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001058wurfl-data-file <file path>
1059 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1060 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1061
1062 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1063 with USE_WURFL=1.
1064
1065wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1066 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1067 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1068 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1069
1070 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1071
1072 Valid WURFL properties are:
1073 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1074
1075 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1076 device.
1077
1078 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1079 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1080
1081 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1082 particular web request.
1083
1084 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1085 used Libwurfl API version.
1086
1087 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1088 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1089 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1090
1091 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1092 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1093
1094 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1095 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1096
1097 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1098
1099 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1100
1101 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1102 with USE_WURFL=1.
1103
1104wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1105 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1106 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1107
1108 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1109 with USE_WURFL=1.
1110
1111wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1112 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1113 thus before the chroot.
1114
1115 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1116 with USE_WURFL=1.
1117
1118wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1119 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1120 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1121 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1122 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1123 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1124 mode is enabled by default.
1125
1126 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1127 with USE_WURFL=1.
1128
1129wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1130 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1131 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1132 - "0" : no cache is used.
1133 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1134 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1135 the highest performing option.
1136
1137 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1138 with USE_WURFL=1.
1139
1140wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1141 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1142 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1143
1144 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1145 with USE_WURFL=1.
1146
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011483.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149-----------------------
1150
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001151max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1152 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1153 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1154 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1155 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1156 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1157 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1158 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1159 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1160
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001161maxconn <number>
1162 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1163 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1164 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001165 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1166 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1167 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1168 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001169 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1170 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1171 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1172 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1173 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001174
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001175maxconnrate <number>
1176 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1177 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1178 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1179 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1180 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1181 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1182 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1183 fairness.
1184
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001185maxcomprate <number>
1186 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001187 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001188 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1189 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1190 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1191 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1192 default value.
1193
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001194maxcompcpuusage <number>
1195 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1196 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1197 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1198 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1199 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1200 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1201 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1202 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1203
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001204maxpipes <number>
1205 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1206 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1207 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1208 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1209 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1210 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1211
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001212maxsessrate <number>
1213 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1214 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1215 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1216 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1217 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1218 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1219 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1220 fairness.
1221
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001222maxsslconn <number>
1223 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1224 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1225 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1226 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1227 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1228 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1229 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001230 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1231 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1232 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1233 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1234 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1235 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1236 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001237
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001238maxsslrate <number>
1239 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1240 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1241 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1242 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1243 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1244 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1245 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1246 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1247 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1248 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1249
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001250maxzlibmem <number>
1251 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1252 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1253 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001254 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1255 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1256 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1257
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001258noepoll
1259 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1260 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001261 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001262
1263nokqueue
1264 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1265 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1266 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1267
1268nopoll
1269 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1270 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001271 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001272 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001273
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001274nosplice
1275 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1276 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1277 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001278 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001279 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1280 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1281 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1282 "option splice-response".
1283
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001284nogetaddrinfo
1285 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1286 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1287
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001288noreuseport
1289 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1290 command line argument "-dR".
1291
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001292spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001293 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1294 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1295 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1296 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1297 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1298 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001299
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001300ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-seperated list of algorithms>]
1301 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
1302 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
1303 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1304 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1305 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1306 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1307 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
1308 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1309 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-seperated list
1310 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1311 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1312 openssl configuration file uses:
1313 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1314
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001315ssl-mode-async
1316 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001317 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001318 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1319 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1320 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1321 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1322 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001323
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001324tune.buffers.limit <number>
1325 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1326 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1327 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1328 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1329 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1330 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1331 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1332 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1333 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1334 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1335 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1336 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1337 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1338 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1339 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1340
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001341tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1342 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1343 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1344 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1345 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1346
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001347tune.bufsize <number>
1348 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1349 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1350 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1351 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1352 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1353 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1354 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1355 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001356 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1357 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1358 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001359
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001360tune.chksize <number>
1361 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1362 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1363 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1364 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1365 checks whenever possible.
1366
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001367tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1368 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1369 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1370 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1371 this value. The default value is 1.
1372
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001373tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1374 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1375 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1376 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1377 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1378 change it.
1379
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001380tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1381 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
1382 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgement from haproxy. This setting
1383 only affects payload contents (ie: the body of POST requests), not headers.
1384 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1385 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1386 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1387 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1388 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1389
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001390tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1391 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1392 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1393 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1394 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1395 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1396 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1397 recommended not to change this value.
1398
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001399tune.http.cookielen <number>
1400 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1401 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1402 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1403 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1404 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1405 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1406 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1407 to change this value.
1408
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001409tune.http.logurilen <number>
1410 Sets the maximum length of request uri in logs. This prevent to truncate long
1411 requests uris with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
1412 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
1413 'log ... len yyyy' parameter. Your syslog deamon may also need specific
1414 configuration directives too.
1415 The default value is 1024.
1416
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001417tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1418 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1419 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1420 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1421 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1422 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1423 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001424 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1425 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1426 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001427
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001428tune.idletimer <timeout>
1429 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1430 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1431 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1432 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1433 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1434 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1435 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1436 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1437 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1438
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001439tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1440 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001441 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001442 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1443 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1444 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1445 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1446 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1447
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001448tune.lua.maxmem
1449 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1450 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1451 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1452 memory.
1453
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001454tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1455 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001456 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1457 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1458 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001459
1460tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1461 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1462 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1463 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1464 check servers.
1465
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001466tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1467 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1468 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1469 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1470 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1471
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001472tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001473 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1474 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1475 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1476 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1477 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1478 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1479 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1480 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1481 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1482 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001483
1484tune.maxpollevents <number>
1485 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1486 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1487 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1488 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1489 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1490
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001491tune.maxrewrite <number>
1492 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1493 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1494 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1495 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1496 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1497 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1498 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1499 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1500 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1501 bufsize.
1502
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001503tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1504 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1505 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1506 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1507 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1508 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1509 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1510 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1511 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1512 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1513 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1514 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1515 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1516 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1517 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1518 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1519 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1520 setting this parameter to 0.
1521
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001522tune.pipesize <number>
1523 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1524 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1525 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1526 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1527 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1528 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1529
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001530tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1531tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1532 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1533 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1534 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1535 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1536 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1537 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1538 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1539
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001540tune.recv_enough <number>
1541 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1542 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1543 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1544 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1545 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1546
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001547tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1548tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1549 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1550 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1551 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1552 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1553 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1554 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1555 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1556 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1557 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1558 notifying haproxy again.
1559
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001560tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001561 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1562 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1563 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001564 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001565 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1566 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1567 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1568 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1569 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001570 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1571 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001572
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001573tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1574 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1575 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1576 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1577 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1578 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1579 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1580
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001581tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1582 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001583 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001584 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1585 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1586 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1587 being used for too long.
1588
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001589tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1590 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1591 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1592 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1593 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1594 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1595 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1596 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1597 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1598 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1599 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001600 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1601 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001602
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001603tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1604 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1605 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1606 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1607 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1608 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1609 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1610 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001611 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1612 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001613
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001614tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1615 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1616 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1617 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1618 1000 entries.
1619
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001620tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1621 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1622 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1623 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1624
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001625tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001626tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001627tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1628tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1629tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001630 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1631 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1632 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1633 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1634 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1635 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1636 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1637 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001638
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001639 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1640 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1641 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1642 all available space is consumed.
1643 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1644 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1645 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001646
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001647tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1648 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001649 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001650 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1651 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1652 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1653
1654tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1655 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1656 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1657 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1658 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016603.3. Debugging
1661--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001662
1663debug
1664 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1665 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1666 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1667 system startup.
1668
1669quiet
1670 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1671 line argument "-q".
1672
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016743.4. Userlists
1675--------------
1676It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1677http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1678it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1679
1680userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001681 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001682 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1683
1684group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001685 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001686 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1687 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1688
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001689user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1690 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001691 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1692 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001693 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1694 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001695 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001696 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001697
1698
1699 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001700 userlist L1
1701 group G1 users tiger,scott
1702 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001703
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001704 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1705 user scott insecure-password elgato
1706 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001707
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001708 userlist L2
1709 group G1
1710 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001711
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001712 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1713 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1714 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001715
1716 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001717
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001718
17193.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001720----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001721It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1722several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1723instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1724values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1725automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1726In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1727using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1728tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1729reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1730Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1731that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1732each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001733
1734peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001735 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001736 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1737
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001738disabled
1739 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1740 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1741 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1742
1743enable
1744 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1745
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001746peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1747 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1748 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1749 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1750 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1751 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1752 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1753
1754 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1755 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1756
1757 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1758 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1759 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1760 across all peers.
1761
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001762 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1763 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001764
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001765 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001766 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001767 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1768 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1769 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001770
1771 backend mybackend
1772 mode tcp
1773 balance roundrobin
1774 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1775 stick on src
1776
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001777 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1778 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001779
1780
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090017813.6. Mailers
1782------------
1783It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1784If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1785in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1786
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001787mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001788 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1789 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1790
1791mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1792 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1793
1794 Example:
1795 mailers mymailers
1796 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1797 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1798
1799 backend mybackend
1800 mode tcp
1801 balance roundrobin
1802
1803 email-alert mailers mymailers
1804 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1805 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1806
1807 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1808 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1809
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001810timeout mail <time>
1811 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1812 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1813 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1814 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1815
1816 Example:
1817 mailers mymailers
1818 timeout mail 20s
1819 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001820
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018214. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001822----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001823
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001824Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001825 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001826 - frontend <name>
1827 - backend <name>
1828 - listen <name>
1829
1830A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1831its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1832section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001833section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001834
1835A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1836connections.
1837
1838A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1839to forward incoming connections.
1840
1841A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1842parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1843
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001844All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1845'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1846case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1847
1848Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1849logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1850proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1851However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1852name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1853
1854Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1855and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001856bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1858modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1859arbitrary criteria.
1860
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001861In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1862a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1863the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1864
1865 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1866 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1867 between responses and new requests.
1868
1869 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1870 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1871 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1872 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1873
1874 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1875 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1876 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1877
1878 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1879 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1880 client-facing connection remains open.
1881
1882 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1883 after the end of the response.
1884
1885The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1886frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1887following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1888weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1889
1890 Backend mode
1891
1892 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1893 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1894 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1895 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1896 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1897 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1898 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1899 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1900 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1901 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1902 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1903
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001904
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019064.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1907--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001908
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001909The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1910limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1911they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1912limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001913marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001914option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001915and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1916with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1917specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001918
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001919
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001920 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1921------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1922acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001923appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001924backlog X X X -
1925balance X - X X
1926bind - X X -
1927bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001928block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001929capture cookie - X X -
1930capture request header - X X -
1931capture response header - X X -
1932clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001933compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001934contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1935cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001936declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001937default-server X - X X
1938default_backend X X X -
1939description - X X X
1940disabled X X X X
1941dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001942email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001943email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001944email-alert mailers X X X X
1945email-alert myhostname X X X X
1946email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001947enabled X X X X
1948errorfile X X X X
1949errorloc X X X X
1950errorloc302 X X X X
1951-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1952errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001953force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001954filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001955fullconn X - X X
1956grace X X X X
1957hash-type X - X X
1958http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001959http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001960http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001961http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001962http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001963http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001964http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001965id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001966ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001967load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001968log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001969log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001970log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001971log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001972max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001973maxconn X X X -
1974mode X X X X
1975monitor fail - X X -
1976monitor-net X X X -
1977monitor-uri X X X -
1978option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1979option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1980option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1981option allbackups (*) X - X X
1982option checkcache (*) X - X X
1983option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1984option contstats (*) X X X -
1985option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1986option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1987option forceclose (*) X X X X
1988-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1989option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001990option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001991option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001992option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001993option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001994option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001995option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001996option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001997option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1998option httpchk X - X X
1999option httpclose (*) X X X X
2000option httplog X X X X
2001option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002002option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002003option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002004option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002005option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2006option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2007option logasap (*) X X X -
2008option mysql-check X - X X
2009option nolinger (*) X X X X
2010option originalto X X X X
2011option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002012option pgsql-check X - X X
2013option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002014option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002015option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002016option smtpchk X - X X
2017option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2018option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2019option splice-request (*) X X X X
2020option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002021option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002022option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2023option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2024-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002025option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002026option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2027option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2028option tcpka X X X X
2029option tcplog X X X X
2030option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002031external-check command X - X X
2032external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002033persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2034rate-limit sessions X X X -
2035redirect - X X X
2036redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2037redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2038reqadd - X X X
2039reqallow - X X X
2040reqdel - X X X
2041reqdeny - X X X
2042reqiallow - X X X
2043reqidel - X X X
2044reqideny - X X X
2045reqipass - X X X
2046reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002047reqitarpit - X X X
2048reqpass - X X X
2049reqrep - X X X
2050-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002051reqtarpit - X X X
2052retries X - X X
2053rspadd - X X X
2054rspdel - X X X
2055rspdeny - X X X
2056rspidel - X X X
2057rspideny - X X X
2058rspirep - X X X
2059rsprep - X X X
2060server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002061server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002062server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002063source X - X X
2064srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002065stats admin - X X X
2066stats auth X X X X
2067stats enable X X X X
2068stats hide-version X X X X
2069stats http-request - X X X
2070stats realm X X X X
2071stats refresh X X X X
2072stats scope X X X X
2073stats show-desc X X X X
2074stats show-legends X X X X
2075stats show-node X X X X
2076stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002077-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2078stick match - - X X
2079stick on - - X X
2080stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002081stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002082stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002083tcp-check connect - - X X
2084tcp-check expect - - X X
2085tcp-check send - - X X
2086tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002087tcp-request connection - X X -
2088tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002089tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002090tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002091tcp-response content - - X X
2092tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002093timeout check X - X X
2094timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002095timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002096timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2097timeout connect X - X X
2098timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2099timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2100timeout http-request X X X X
2101timeout queue X - X X
2102timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002103timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002104timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2105timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002106timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002107transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002108unique-id-format X X X -
2109unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002110use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002111use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002112------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2113 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002114
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021164.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2117---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002118
2119This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2120
2121
2122acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2123 Declare or complete an access list.
2124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2125 no | yes | yes | yes
2126 Example:
2127 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2128 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2129 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2130
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002131 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002132
2133
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002134appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2135 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002136 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2138 no | no | yes | yes
2139 Arguments :
2140 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2141 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2142
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002143 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002144 checked in each cookie value.
2145
2146 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2147 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2148 milliseconds.
2149
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002150 request-learn
2151 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2152 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2153 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2154 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2155 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2156 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2157
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002158 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2159 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2160 data following this prefix.
2161
2162 Example :
2163 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2164
2165 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2166 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2167
2168 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2169 2 modes are currently supported :
2170 - path-parameters :
2171 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2172 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2173 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2174 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2175 - query-string :
2176 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2177 query string.
2178
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002179 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2180 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2181 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002182
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002183 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2184 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002185
2186
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002187backlog <conns>
2188 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2190 yes | yes | yes | no
2191 Arguments :
2192 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2193 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002194 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002195
2196 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2197 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2198 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2199 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2200 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2201 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2202 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2203 backlog parameter.
2204
2205 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2206 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2207 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2208
2209 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2210
2211
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002212balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002213balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002214 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2216 yes | no | yes | yes
2217 Arguments :
2218 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2219 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2220 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2221 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2222
2223 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2224 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2225 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2226 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002227 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002228 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002229 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2230 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2231 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2232 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2233 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2234 it, so that you don't worry.
2235
2236 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2237 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2238 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2239 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2240 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2241 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2242 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2243 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002244
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002245 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2246 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2247 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2248 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2249 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2250 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2251 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2252 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2253
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002254 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002255 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002256 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2257 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002258 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002259 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2260 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2261 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2262 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2263 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002264 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2265 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2266 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2267 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2268 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2269 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002270
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002271 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2272 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2273 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2274 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2275 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2276 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2277 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2278 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002279 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002280 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002281 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2282 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2283 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002284
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002285 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2286 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2287 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2288 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2289 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2290 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2291 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2292 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2293 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2294 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2295 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2296 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002297
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002298 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002299 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2300 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2301 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2302 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2303 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2304 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2305 URIs start with a leading "/".
2306
2307 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2308 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2309 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2310 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2311
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002312 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002313 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2314
2315 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002316 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2317 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002318 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2319 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2320 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2321 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002322 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002323 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2324 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002325
2326 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2327 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2328 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2329 server will receive the request.
2330
2331 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2332 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2333 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2334 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2335 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002336 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2337 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2338 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002339
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002340 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2341 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2342 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2343 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2344 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002346 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002347 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2348 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2349 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2350
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002351 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2352 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2353 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2354
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002355 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002356 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002357 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2358 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2359 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2360 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2361 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2362 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002363 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002364 used instead.
2365
2366 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2367 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2368 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2369 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2370
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002371 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2372 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2373 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2374
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002375 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002376
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002377 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002378 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2379 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002380
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002381 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2382 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2383 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002384
2385 Examples :
2386 balance roundrobin
2387 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002388 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002389 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2390 balance hdr(host)
2391 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002392
2393 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2394 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002396 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002397 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2398 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2399 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2400 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2401
2402 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2403 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2404 defaults to 16 kB.
2405
2406 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2407 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2408
2409 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2410 Round Robin.
2411
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002412 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002413 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2414 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2415 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2416
2417 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2418
2419 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002420 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002421 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2422 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2423 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002425 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002426
2427
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002428bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2429bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002430 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2432 no | yes | yes | no
2433 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002434 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2435 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2436 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2437 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002438 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002439 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2440 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2441 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2442 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2443 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2444 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2445 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002446 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2447 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2448 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2449 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2450 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2451 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2452 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002453 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2454 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2455 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002456 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2457 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2458 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002459
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002460 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2461 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002462 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2463 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2464 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002465 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2466 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2467 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2468 the range.
2469
2470 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2471 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2472 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2473 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2474 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2475 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2476 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002477 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002478 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002479
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002480 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2481 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2482 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2483 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2484 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2485 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2486 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2487 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2488
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002489 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2490 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2491 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2492 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002493
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002494 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2495 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2496 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2497 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2498 in a frontend.
2499
2500 Example :
2501 listen http_proxy
2502 bind :80,:443
2503 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002504 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002505
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002506 listen http_https_proxy
2507 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002508 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002509
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002510 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2511 bind ipv6@:80
2512 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2513 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2514
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002515 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002516 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002517
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002518 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2519 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2520 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2521 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2522 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2523
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002524 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002525 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002526
2527
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002528bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002529 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2531 yes | yes | yes | yes
2532 Arguments :
2533 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2534 may be used to override a default value.
2535
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002536 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002537 option may be combined with other numbers.
2538
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002539 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002540 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2541 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2542 missing from all processes.
2543
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002544 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002545 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002546 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2547 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2548 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2549 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002550
2551 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2552 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2553 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2554 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2555 and 'even' instances.
2556
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002557 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2558 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2559 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2560 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002561
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002562 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2563 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2564
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002565 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2566 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2567 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2568
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002569 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2570 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2571
2572 Example :
2573 listen app_ip1
2574 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002575 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002576
2577 listen app_ip2
2578 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002579 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002580
2581 listen management
2582 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002583 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002584
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002585 listen management
2586 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2587 bind-process 1-4
2588
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002589 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002590
2591
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002592block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002593 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2595 no | yes | yes | yes
2596
2597 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2598 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002599 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002600 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002602 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2603 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2604 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002605
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002606 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2607 "http-request deny" instead.
2608
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002609 Example:
2610 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2611 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2612 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002613 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2614 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2615 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002616
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002617 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2618 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2619 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002620
2621capture cookie <name> len <length>
2622 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2624 no | yes | yes | no
2625 Arguments :
2626 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2627 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2628 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2629 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2630 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2631
2632 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2633 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2634 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2635 right if it exceeds <length>.
2636
2637 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2638 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2639 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2640 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2641
2642 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2643 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2644 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2645
2646 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2647 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2648 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002649 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2650 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2651 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002652
2653 Example:
2654 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2655
2656 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002657 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002658
2659
2660capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002661 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2663 no | yes | yes | no
2664 Arguments :
2665 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002666 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2668 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2669 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2670
2671 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2672 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2673 it exceeds <length>.
2674
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002675 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002676 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2677 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002678 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2679 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2680 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2681 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002682 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002683 environments to find where the request came from.
2684
2685 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2686 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2687 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2688 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002689
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002690 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2691 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2692 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2693 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2694 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002695
2696 Example:
2697 capture request header Host len 15
2698 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002699 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002701 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702 about logging.
2703
2704
2705capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002706 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2708 no | yes | yes | no
2709 Arguments :
2710 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002711 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2713 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2714 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2715
2716 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2717 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2718 it exceeds <length>.
2719
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002720 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002721 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2722 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2723 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002724 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2725 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2726 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2727 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002728
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002729 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2730 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2731 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2732 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2733 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002734
2735 Example:
2736 capture response header Content-length len 9
2737 capture response header Location len 15
2738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002739 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002740 about logging.
2741
2742
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002743clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002744 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2746 yes | yes | yes | no
2747 Arguments :
2748 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2749 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2750 as explained at the top of this document.
2751
2752 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2753 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2754 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2755 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2756 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2757 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2758 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2759 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002760 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2762 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2763
2764 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2765 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2766 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2767 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2768 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2769 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2770
2771 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2772 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2773
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002774 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2775 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002776
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002777compression algo <algorithm> ...
2778compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002779compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002780 Enable HTTP compression.
2781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2782 yes | yes | yes | yes
2783 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002784 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2785 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2786 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2787
2788 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002789 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2790 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2791 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002792
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002793 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002794 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002795
2796 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2797 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2798 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2799 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2800 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002801 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002802
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002803 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2804 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2805 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2806 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2807 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2808 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2809 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002810 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002811
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002812 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002813 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002814 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2815 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2816 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2817 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2818 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002819
2820 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2821 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2822 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2823 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2824 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002825 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2826 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2827 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2828 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2829 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002830 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2831 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002832
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002833 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002834 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2835 "Accept-Encoding" header
2836 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002837 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002838 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2839 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002840 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2841 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2842 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2843 "multipart"
2844 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2845 header
2846 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2847 and later
2848 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2849 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002850
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002851 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2852 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002853
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002854 Examples :
2855 compression algo gzip
2856 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002857
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002858
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002859contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002860 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2862 yes | no | yes | yes
2863 Arguments :
2864 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2865 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2866 as explained at the top of this document.
2867
2868 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002869 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002870 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002871 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2872 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2873 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2874 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2875
2876 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2877 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2878 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2879 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2880 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2881 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2882
2883 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2884 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2885 instead.
2886
2887 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2888 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2889
2890
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002891cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002892 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2893 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002894 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002895 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2897 yes | no | yes | yes
2898 Arguments :
2899 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2900 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2901 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2902 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2903 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2904 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2905 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2906 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2907 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2908
2909 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2910 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2911 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2912 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2913 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2914 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002915 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2916 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2917 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2918 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2919 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002920
2921 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002922 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002923
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002924 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002925 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2926 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2927 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2928 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2929 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2930 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2931 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2932 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2933 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2934 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935
2936 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2937 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2938 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2939 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2940 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2941 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2942 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2943 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2944 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002945 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002946 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2947 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2948 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002949
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002950 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2951 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2952 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002953 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2954 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2955 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2956 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002957 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2958 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2959 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002960
2961 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2962 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2963 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2964 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2965 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2966 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2967 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2968 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2969 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2970
2971 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2972 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2973 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2974 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2975 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2976 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2977 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2978 persistence cookie in the cache.
2979 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2980
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002981 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2982 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2983 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2984 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2985 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2986 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2987 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2988 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2989 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2990 they logout.
2991
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002992 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2993 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2994 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2995 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2996
2997 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2998 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2999 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3000 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3001 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3002 this attribute.
3003
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003004 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003005 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003006 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3007 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3008 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3009 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3010 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3011 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003012
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003013 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3014 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3015 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3016 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3017 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3018 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3019 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3020 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3021 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
3022 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3023 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3024 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3025 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3026 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3027 the site.
3028
3029 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3030 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3031 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3032 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3033 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3034 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3035 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3036 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3037 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3038 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3039 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3040 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3041 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3042 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
3043 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3044 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3045
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003046 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3047 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3048 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3049 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3050 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3051 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3052
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003053 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3054 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3055 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3056 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003057
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003058 Examples :
3059 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3060 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3061 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003062 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003064 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003065
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003066
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003067declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3068 Declares a capture slot.
3069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3070 no | yes | yes | no
3071 Arguments:
3072 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3073
3074 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3075 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3076 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3077 for use in the response.
3078
3079 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003080 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003081 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3082
3083
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003084default-server [param*]
3085 Change default options for a server in a backend
3086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3087 yes | no | yes | yes
3088 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003089 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3090 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3091 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3092 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003093
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003094 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003095 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3096
3097 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003098
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003099
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003100default_backend <backend>
3101 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3103 yes | yes | yes | no
3104 Arguments :
3105 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3106
3107 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3108 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3109 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3110 will catch all undetermined requests.
3111
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003112 Example :
3113
3114 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3115 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3116 default_backend dynamic
3117
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003118 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003119
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003121description <string>
3122 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3124 no | yes | yes | yes
3125 Arguments : string
3126
3127 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3128 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3129 it describes.
3130 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3131
3132
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003133disabled
3134 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3136 yes | yes | yes | yes
3137 Arguments : none
3138
3139 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3140 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3141 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3142 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3143 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3144 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3145 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3146
3147 See also : "enabled"
3148
3149
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003150dispatch <address>:<port>
3151 Set a default server address
3152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3153 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003154 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003155
3156 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3157 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3158 during start-up.
3159
3160 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3161 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3162 possible with normal servers.
3163
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003164 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003165 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3166 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3167 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3168 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3169
3170 See also : "server"
3171
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003172
3173dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3174 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3176 yes | no | yes | yes
3177 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3178
3179 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3180 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3181 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3182 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3183 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3184 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003185
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003186enabled
3187 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3189 yes | yes | yes | yes
3190 Arguments : none
3191
3192 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3193 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3194
3195 See also : "disabled"
3196
3197
3198errorfile <code> <file>
3199 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3201 yes | yes | yes | yes
3202 Arguments :
3203 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003204 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3205 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206
3207 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003208 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003209 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003210 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3211 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003212
3213 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3214 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3215 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3216
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003217 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3218
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003219 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3220 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3221 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3222 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3223
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003224 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3225 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3226 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3227 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3228 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3229 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3230
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003231 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3232 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3233 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003234 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003235 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3236
3237 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3238
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003239 Example :
3240 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003241 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003242 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3243 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3244
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003245
3246errorloc <code> <url>
3247errorloc302 <code> <url>
3248 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3250 yes | yes | yes | yes
3251 Arguments :
3252 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003253 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3254 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003255
3256 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3257 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3258 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3259 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3260 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3261
3262 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3263 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3264 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3265
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003266 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3267
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003268 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3269 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3270 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3271 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003272 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003273 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3274 request.
3275
3276 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3277
3278
3279errorloc303 <code> <url>
3280 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3282 yes | yes | yes | yes
3283 Arguments :
3284 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003285 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3286 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003287
3288 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3289 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3290 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3291 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3292 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3293
3294 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3295 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3296 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3297
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003298 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3299
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003300 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3301 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3302 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3303 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003304 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003305
3306 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3307
3308
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003309email-alert from <emailaddr>
3310 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3311 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3313 yes | yes | yes | yes
3314
3315 Arguments :
3316
3317 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3318
3319 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3320 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3321
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003322 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003323 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3324 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003325
3326
3327email-alert level <level>
3328 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3329 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3330 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3331 yes | yes | yes | yes
3332
3333 Arguments :
3334
3335 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3336 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3337 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3338
3339 By default level is alert
3340
3341 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3342 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3343 for the proxy.
3344
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003345 Alerts are sent when :
3346
3347 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3348 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3349 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3350 is notice or lower
3351 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3352 and a health check status update occurs
3353
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003354 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3355 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003356 section 3.6 about mailers.
3357
3358
3359email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3360 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3361 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3362 yes | yes | yes | yes
3363
3364 Arguments :
3365
3366 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3367
3368 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3369 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3370
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003371 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3372 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003373
3374
3375email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3376 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3377 mailers.
3378 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3379 yes | yes | yes | yes
3380
3381 Arguments :
3382
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003383 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003384
3385 By default the systems hostname is used.
3386
3387 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3388 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3389 for the proxy.
3390
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003391 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3392 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003393
3394
3395email-alert to <emailaddr>
3396 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3397 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3398 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3399 yes | yes | yes | yes
3400
3401 Arguments :
3402
3403 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3404
3405 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3406 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3407
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003408 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003409 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3410
3411
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003412force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3413 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3414 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3415 no | yes | yes | yes
3416
3417 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3418 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3419 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3420 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3421 marked down for maintenance operations.
3422
3423 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3424 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3425 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3426 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3427 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3428 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3429 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3430 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3431 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3432
3433 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3434 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3435 is used.
3436
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003437 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003438 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003439
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003440
3441filter <name> [param*]
3442 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3444 no | yes | yes | yes
3445 Arguments :
3446 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3447 referenced in section 9.
3448
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003449 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003450 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003451 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3452 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003453
3454 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3455 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3456
3457 Example:
3458 listen
3459 bind *:80
3460
3461 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3462 filter compression
3463 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3464
3465 compression algo gzip
3466 compression offload
3467
3468 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3469
3470 See also : section 9.
3471
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003472
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003473fullconn <conns>
3474 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3476 yes | no | yes | yes
3477 Arguments :
3478 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3479 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3480
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003481 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003482 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003483 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003484 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3485 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3486 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3487 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3488 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003489 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003490
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003491 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3492 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003493 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3494 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3495 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003496
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003497 Example :
3498 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3499 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3500 # connections.
3501 backend dynamic
3502 fullconn 10000
3503 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3504 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3505
3506 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3507
3508
3509grace <time>
3510 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003512 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003513 Arguments :
3514 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3515 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3516 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3517
3518 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3519 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003520 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003521 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3522
3523 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3524 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3525 simplify it.
3526
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003527
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003528hash-balance-factor <factor>
3529 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3531 yes | no | no | yes
3532 Arguments :
3533 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3534 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3535 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3536
3537 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3538 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3539 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3540 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3541 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3542 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3543 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3544
3545 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3546 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3547 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3548 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3549 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3550
3551 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3552
3553
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003554hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003555 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3557 yes | no | yes | yes
3558 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003559 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3560 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003561
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003562 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3563 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3564 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3565 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3566 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3567 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3568 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3569 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3570 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3571 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003572
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003573 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3574 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3575 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3576 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3577 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3578 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3579 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3580 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3581 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3582 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3583 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3584 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3585 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003586 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3587 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003588
3589 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3590
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003591 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003592 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3593 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3594 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003595 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3596 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3597 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003598
3599 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3600 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003601 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3602 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3603 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3604 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3605
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003606 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3607 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3608 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3609 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3610 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3611 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3612 parameter.
3613
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003614 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3615 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3616 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3617 used on strings.
3618
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003619 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3620
3621 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3622 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3623 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3624 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3625 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3626 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3627 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3628 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3629 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3630 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3631 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3632 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003633
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003634 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3635 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3636 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003637
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003638 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003639
3640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003641http-check disable-on-404
3642 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003644 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003645 Arguments : none
3646
3647 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3648 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3649 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3650 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3651 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3652 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3653 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3654 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003655 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3656 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3657 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3658
3659 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3660
3661
3662http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003663 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003665 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003666 Arguments :
3667 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3668 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003669 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003670 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3671 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3672 details on the supported keywords.
3673
3674 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3675 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3676 with the usual backslash ('\').
3677
3678 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3679 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3680 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3681 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3682 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3683
3684 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003685 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003686 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3687 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3688 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3689
3690 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003691 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003692 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3693 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3694 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3695 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3696
3697 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003698 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003699 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3700 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3701 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3702 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3703 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3704 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3705 trace).
3706
3707 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003708 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003709 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3710 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3711 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3712 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3713 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3714 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3715
3716 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3717 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3718 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3719 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3720 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3721 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3722 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3723 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3724
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003725 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3726 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3727 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3728
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003729 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3730 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3731
3732 Examples :
3733 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003734 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003735
3736 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003737 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003738
3739 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003740 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003741
3742 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003743 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003744
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003745 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003746
3747
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003748http-check send-state
3749 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3751 yes | no | yes | yes
3752 Arguments : none
3753
3754 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3755 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3756 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3757 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3758 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3759
3760 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3761 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3762 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3763 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3764 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003765 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3766 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3767 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3768
3769 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3770 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3771 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3772
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003773 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3774 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3775 checked in multiple backends.
3776
3777 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3778 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3779
3780 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3781 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3782 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3783 one fails.
3784
3785 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3786 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3787 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3788
3789 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3790 server's queue.
3791
3792 Example of a header received by the application server :
3793 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3794 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3795
3796 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3797
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003798http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3799 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003800 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003801 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003802 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003803 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3804 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003805 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3806 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003807 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3808 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3809 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003810 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003811 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003812 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003813 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003814 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003815 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003816 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02003817 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003818 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003819 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003820 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3821
3822 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3823 no | yes | yes | yes
3824
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003825 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3826 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3827 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3828 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3829 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003830
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003831 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3832 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3833 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3834
3835 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003836 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3837 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3838 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3839 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003840
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003841 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3842 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3843 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003844 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3845 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003846 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3847 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3848 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3849 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3850 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003851 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003852 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3853 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003854
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003855 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3856 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3857 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3858 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3859 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3860
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003861 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3862 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3863 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003864 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3865 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003866
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003867 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3868 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3869 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3870 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3871 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3872 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3873 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3874 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3875
3876 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3877 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3878 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003879 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3880 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003881
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003882 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3883 <name>.
3884
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003885 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3886 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3887 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3888 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3889 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3890 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3891 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3892 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3893
3894 Example:
3895
3896 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3897
3898 applied to:
3899
3900 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3901
3902 outputs:
3903
3904 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3905
3906 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3907
3908 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3909 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3910 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3911 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3912 header.
3913
3914 Example:
3915
3916 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3917
3918 applied to:
3919
3920 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3921
3922 outputs:
3923
3924 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3925
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003926 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3927 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3928 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3929 it.
3930
3931 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3932 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3933 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3934 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3935 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3936 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3937
3938 Example :
3939 # prepend the host name before the path
3940 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3941
3942 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3943 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3944 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3945 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3946 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3947 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3948 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3949 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3950
3951 Example :
3952 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3953 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3954
3955 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3956 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3957 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3958 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3959 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3960 "set-query".
3961
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003962 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3963 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3964 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3965 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3966 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3967 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3968 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3969 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3970
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003971 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3972 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3973 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3974 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3975 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3976 another equipment.
3977
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003978 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3979 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3980 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3981 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3982 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3983 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3984 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3985 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3986
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003987 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3988 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3989 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3990 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3991 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3992 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3993 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3994 admin privileges.
3995
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003996 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3997 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3998 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3999 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4000 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4001 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4002 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4003 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4004
4005 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4006 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4007 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4008 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4009 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4010 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4011
4012 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4013 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4014 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4015 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4016 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4017 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4018
4019 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4020 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4021 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4022 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4023 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4024 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4025 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4026 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4027 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4028
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004029 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004030 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
4031 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4032 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
4033 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
4034 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
4035 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
4036 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
4037 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4038 request header" for more information.
4039
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004040 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
4041 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
4042 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4043 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004044 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4045 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004046
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004047 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4048 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
4049 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
4050 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
4051 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
4052 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4053 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4054 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4055 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4056 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4057 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4058 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4059
4060 These actions take one or two arguments :
4061 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4062 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
4063 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
4064 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4065
4066 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4067 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4068 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4069 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4070
4071 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4072 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4073 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4074 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4075 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4076 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4077 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4078 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4079
4080 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4081 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4082 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4083 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4084 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4085
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004086 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4087 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4088 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4089 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4090 continues.
4091
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004092 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4093 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4094 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4095 the actions evaluation continues.
4096
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004097 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4098 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4099 inline.
4100
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004101 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4102 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004103 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004104 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4105 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004106 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004107 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004108 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004109 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4110 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004111 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004112 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004113 and '_'.
4114
4115 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4116 followed by some converters.
4117
4118 Example:
4119
4120 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4121
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004122 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4123 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4124
4125 Example:
4126
4127 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4128
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004129 - set-src <expr> :
4130 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4131 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4132 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4133 source IP for privacy.
4134
4135 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4136 followed by some converters.
4137
4138 Example:
4139
4140 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4141 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4142
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004143 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4144 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004145
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004146 - set-src-port <expr> :
4147 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4148 expression.
4149
4150 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4151 followed by some converters.
4152
4153 Example:
4154
4155 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4156 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4157
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004158 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4159 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4160 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004161
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004162 - set-dst <expr> :
4163 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4164 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4165 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4166 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4167 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4168
4169 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4170 followed by some converters.
4171
4172 Example:
4173
4174 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4175 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4176
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004177 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4178 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4179
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004180 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4181 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4182 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4183 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4184
4185 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4186 followed by some converters.
4187
4188 Example:
4189
4190 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4191 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4192
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004193 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4194 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4195 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4196
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004197 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4198 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4199 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4200 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4201 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4202 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4203 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4204 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4205 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4206 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4207 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4208 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4209 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4210 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4211 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4212 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4213
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004214
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004215 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4216 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4217 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4218
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004219 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4220 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4221 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4222 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4223 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4224 SPOE agent name must be used.
4225
4226 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4227
4228 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4229 configuration.
4230
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004231 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4232
4233 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4234 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004235 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4236 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4237
4238 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4239 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4240 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4241 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004242
4243 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004244 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4245 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4246 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004247
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004248 http-request allow if nagios
4249 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4250 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4251 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004252
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004253 Example:
4254 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004255 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004256
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004257 Example:
4258 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4259 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004260 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004261 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4262 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4263 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4264 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4265 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4266 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4267
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004268 Example:
4269 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4270 acl add path /addacl
4271 acl del path /delacl
4272
4273 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4274
4275 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4276 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4277
4278 Example:
4279 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4280 acl setmap path /setmap
4281 acl delmap path /delmap
4282
4283 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4284
4285 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4286 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4287
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004288 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4289 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004290
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004291http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004292 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004293 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004294 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4295 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004296 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004297 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4298 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4299 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4300 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004301 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004302 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004303 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004304 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004305 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004306 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004307 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004308 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004309 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004310 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004311 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4312
4313 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4314 no | yes | yes | yes
4315
4316 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4317 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4318 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4319 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4320 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4321 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4322
4323 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4324 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4325 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4326 current section.
4327
4328 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4329 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4330 rules are evaluated.
4331
4332 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4333 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4334 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4335 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4336 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4337 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4338 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4339
4340 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4341 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4342 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4343 external users.
4344
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004345 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4346 <name>.
4347
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004348 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4349 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4350 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4351 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4352 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4353 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4354 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4355 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4356
4357 Example:
4358
4359 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4360
4361 applied to:
4362
4363 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4364
4365 outputs:
4366
4367 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4368
4369 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4370
4371 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4372 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4373 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4374 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4375 header.
4376
4377 Example:
4378
4379 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4380
4381 applied to:
4382
4383 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4384
4385 outputs:
4386
4387 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4388
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004389 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004390 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4391 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4392 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004393
4394 Example:
4395
4396 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4397 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004398 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4399 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004400
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004401 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4402 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4403 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4404 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4405 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4406 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4407 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4408 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4409
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004410 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4411 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4412 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4413 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4414 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4415 another equipment.
4416
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004417 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4418 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4419 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4420 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4421 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4422 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4423 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4424 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4425
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004426 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4427 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4428 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4429 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4430 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4431 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4432 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4433 admin privileges.
4434
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004435 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4436 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4437 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4438 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4439 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4440 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4441 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4442 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4443
4444 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4445 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4446 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4447 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4448 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4449 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4450
4451 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4452 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4453 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4454 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4455 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4456 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4457
4458 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4459 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4460 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4461 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4462 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4463 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4464 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4465 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4466 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4467
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004468 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4469 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4470 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4471 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4472 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4473 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4474 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4475 response header" for more information.
4476
4477 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4478 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4479 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4480 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4481 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004482 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4483 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004484
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004485 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4486 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4487 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4488 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4489 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4490 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4491
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004492 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4493 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4494 inline.
4495
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004496 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4497 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004498 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004499 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4500 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004501 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004502 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004503 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004504 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4505 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004506 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004507 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4508 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004509
4510 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4511 followed by some converters.
4512
4513 Example:
4514
4515 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4516
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004517 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4518 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4519
4520 Example:
4521
4522 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4523
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004524 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4525 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4526 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4527 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4528 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4529 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4530 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4531
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004532 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4533 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4534 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4535 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4536 continues.
4537
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004538 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4539 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4540 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4541 the actions evaluation continues.
4542
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004543 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4544 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4545 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4546 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4547 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4548 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4549 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4550 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4551 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4552 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4553 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4554 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4555 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4556 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4557 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4558 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4559
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004560 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4561 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4562 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4563 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4564 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4565 SPOE agent name must be used.
4566
4567 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4568
4569 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4570 configuration.
4571
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004572 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4573
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004574 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004575 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4576 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004577 rules.
4578
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004579 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4580 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4581 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4582 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4583
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004584 Example:
4585 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4586
4587 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4588
4589 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4590 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4591
4592 Example:
4593 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4594
4595 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4596
4597 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4598 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4599
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004600 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4601 ACL usage.
4602
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004603
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004604http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4605 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4606
4607 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | no | yes | yes
4609
4610 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4611 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4612 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4613 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4614 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4615 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4616
4617 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4618
4619 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4620 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4621 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4622 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4623 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4624 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4625 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4626 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4627 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4628 not checking any request past the first one.
4629
4630 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4631 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4632 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4633 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4634 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4635 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4636 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4637
4638 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4639 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4640 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4641 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4642 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4643 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4644 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4645 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4646 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4647 downsides of rare connection failures.
4648
4649 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4650 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4651 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4652 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4653 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4654 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4655 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4656 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4657 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4658 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4659 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4660 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4661
4662 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4663 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4664 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4665 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4666
4667 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4668 and are never shared ;
4669
4670 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4671 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4672 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4673 and are never shared ;
4674
4675 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4676 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4677 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4678
4679 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4680 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4681 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4682
4683 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4684
4685
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004686http-send-name-header [<header>]
4687 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4688
4689 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4690 yes | no | yes | yes
4691
4692 Arguments :
4693
4694 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4695
4696 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4697 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4698 is added with the header string proved.
4699
4700 See also : "server"
4701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004702id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004703 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4705 no | yes | yes | yes
4706 Arguments : none
4707
4708 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4709 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4710 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004711
4712
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004713ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4714 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4715 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4716 no | yes | yes | yes
4717
4718 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4719 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4720 and running).
4721
4722 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4723 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4724 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004725 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004726 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4727
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004728 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4729 "unless" condition is met.
4730
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004731 Example:
4732 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4733 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4734 ignore-persist if url_static
4735
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004736 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4737
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004738load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4739 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4740 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 yes | no | yes | yes
4742
4743 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4744 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4745 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4746 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4747 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4748 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4749 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4750 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4751
4752 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4753 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004754 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004755
4756 Arguments:
4757 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4758 named "server-state-file".
4759
4760 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4761 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4762 name is used as a file name.
4763
4764 none don't load any stat for this backend
4765
4766 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004767 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4768 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4769 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4770 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4771 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004772
4773 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4774 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4775
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004776 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004777
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004778 global
4779 stats socket /tmp/socket
4780 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004781
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004782 defaults
4783 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004784
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004785 backend bk
4786 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4787 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004788
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004789
4790 Then one can run :
4791
4792 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4793
4794 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4795
4796 1
4797 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4798 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4799 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4800
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004801 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004802
4803 global
4804 stats socket /tmp/socket
4805 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4806
4807 defaults
4808 load-server-state-from-file local
4809
4810 backend bk
4811 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4812 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4813
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004814
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004815 Then one can run :
4816
4817 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4818
4819 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4820
4821 1
4822 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4823 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4824 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4825
4826 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4827 "show servers state"
4828
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004829
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004830log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004831log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004832no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004833 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4835 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004836
4837 Prefix :
4838 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4839 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4840 prefix does not allow arguments.
4841
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004842 Arguments :
4843 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4844 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4845 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4846 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4847 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4848 parameter.
4849
4850 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4851 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4852
4853 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4854 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4855 standard syslog port).
4856
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004857 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4858 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4859 standard syslog port).
4860
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004861 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4862 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4863 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4864 appropriately writeable).
4865
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004866 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4867 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004868
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004869 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4870 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4871 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4872 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4873 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4874 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4875 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4876 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4877 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4878 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4879 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4880
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004881 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4882
4883 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4884 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4885 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4886
4887 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4888 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4889 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004890 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4891 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4892 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4893 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4894 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004895
4896 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4897
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004898 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4899 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4900 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004901
4902 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4903 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4904 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4905 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4906
4907 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4908 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004909
4910 Example :
4911 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004912 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4913 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004914 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004915
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004916
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004917log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004918 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4919 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4920 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004921
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004922 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4923 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4924 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4925 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4926 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004927
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004928 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4929 "option httplog" directives.
4930
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004931log-format-sd <string>
4932 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | yes | yes | no
4935
4936 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4937 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4938 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4939 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4940 which covers the log format string in depth.
4941
4942 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4943 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4944
4945 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4946 log format to "rfc5424".
4947
4948 Example :
4949 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4950
4951
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004952log-tag <string>
4953 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4954 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4955 yes | yes | yes | yes
4956
4957 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4958 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4959 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4960 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4961 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4962 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4963 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4964 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4965 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004966
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004967max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4968 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4969 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4970 yes | no | yes | yes
4971
4972 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4973 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4974 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4975 servers.
4976
4977 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4978 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4979 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4980 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4981 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4982 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4983 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4984 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4985 picking a different server.
4986
4987 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4988 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4989 even if they have to be queued.
4990
4991 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4992 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4993
4994
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004995maxconn <conns>
4996 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4998 yes | yes | yes | no
4999 Arguments :
5000 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5001 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5002 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5003 closes.
5004
5005 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5006 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5007 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5008 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005009 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5010 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5011 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5012 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005013
5014 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5015 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5016 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5017
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005018 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5019
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005020 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5021
5022
5023mode { tcp|http|health }
5024 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5026 yes | yes | yes | yes
5027 Arguments :
5028 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5029 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5030 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5031 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5032
5033 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5034 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5035 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5036 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5037 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5038
5039 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005040 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5041 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5042 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5043 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5044 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5045 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5046 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005047
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005048 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5049 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5050 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005051
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005052 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005053 defaults http_instances
5054 mode http
5055
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005056 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005057
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005058
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005059monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005060 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5062 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005063 Arguments :
5064 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5065 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005066 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005067 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5068 backend and its backup.
5069
5070 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5071 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5072 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5073 servers in a list of backends.
5074
5075 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5076 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5077 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5078 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5079 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5080 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5081 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005082 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5083 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005084
5085 Example:
5086 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005087 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005088 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5089 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5090 monitor-uri /site_alive
5091 monitor fail if site_dead
5092
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005093 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005094
5095
5096monitor-net <source>
5097 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5099 yes | yes | yes | no
5100 Arguments :
5101 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5102 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5103 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5104 followed by a mask.
5105
5106 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5107 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005108 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005109 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5110
5111 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5112 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5113 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5114 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005115 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5116 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5117 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005118
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005119 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5120 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5121 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5122 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5123 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5124 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005125
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005126 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5127 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005128
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005129 Example :
5130 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5131 frontend www
5132 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5133
5134 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5135
5136
5137monitor-uri <uri>
5138 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5140 yes | yes | yes | no
5141 Arguments :
5142 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5143 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5144
5145 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5146 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5147 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5148 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5149 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5150 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5151 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5152 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5153
5154 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5155 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5156 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5157 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5158 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5159 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5160
5161 Example :
5162 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5163 frontend www
5164 mode http
5165 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5166
5167 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005169
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005170option abortonclose
5171no option abortonclose
5172 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5174 yes | no | yes | yes
5175 Arguments : none
5176
5177 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5178 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5179 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5180 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005181 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005182 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5183 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5184 encountered while delivering the response.
5185
5186 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5187 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5188 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5189 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5190 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5191 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005192 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005193 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005194 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005195 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5196 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5197 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5198
5199 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5200 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5201 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5202 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5203 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5204 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5205 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5206 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005207 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005208
5209 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5210 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5211
5212 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5213
5214
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005215option accept-invalid-http-request
5216no option accept-invalid-http-request
5217 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5219 yes | yes | yes | no
5220 Arguments : none
5221
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005222 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005223 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5224 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5225 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5226 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5227 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5228 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5229 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005230 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5231 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5232 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5233 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5234 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005235 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005236 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5237 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5238 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005239
5240 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5241 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5242 been confirmed.
5243
5244 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5245 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005246 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5247 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005248 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5249
5250 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5251 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5252
5253 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5254 stats socket.
5255
5256
5257option accept-invalid-http-response
5258no option accept-invalid-http-response
5259 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5261 yes | no | yes | yes
5262 Arguments : none
5263
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005264 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005265 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5266 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5267 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5268 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5269 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5270 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5271 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005272 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5273 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5274 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005275
5276 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5277 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5278 been confirmed.
5279
5280 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5281 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5282 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5283 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5284
5285 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5286 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5287
5288 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5289 stats socket.
5290
5291
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005292option allbackups
5293no option allbackups
5294 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5296 yes | no | yes | yes
5297 Arguments : none
5298
5299 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5300 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5301 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5302 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5303 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5304 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5305 order between the backup servers anymore.
5306
5307 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5308 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5309
5310 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5311 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5312
5313
5314option checkcache
5315no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005316 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5318 yes | no | yes | yes
5319 Arguments : none
5320
5321 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5322 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005323 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005324 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5325 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005326 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005327
5328 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005329 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005330 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005331 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5332 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005333 to the client are :
5334 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005335 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005336 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005337 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5338 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5339 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5340 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5341 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5342 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5343 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5344 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5345 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5346 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5347 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5348
5349 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005350 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005351 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005352 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005353 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5354
5355 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5356 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005357 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005358 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5359
5360 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5361 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5362
5363
5364option clitcpka
5365no option clitcpka
5366 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5368 yes | yes | yes | no
5369 Arguments : none
5370
5371 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5372 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5373 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5374 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5375
5376 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5377 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5378 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5379 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5380
5381 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5382 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5383 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5384 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5385 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5386
5387 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5388
5389 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5390 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5391 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5392
5393 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5394 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5395
5396 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5397
5398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005399option contstats
5400 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5402 yes | yes | yes | no
5403 Arguments : none
5404
5405 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5406 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5407 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5408 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005409 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5410 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5411 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5412 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5413 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005414
5415
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005416option dontlog-normal
5417no option dontlog-normal
5418 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5420 yes | yes | yes | no
5421 Arguments : none
5422
5423 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5424 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5425 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5426 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5427 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5428 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5429 logged.
5430
5431 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5432 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5433 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5434
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005435 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005436 logging.
5437
5438
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005439option dontlognull
5440no option dontlognull
5441 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5443 yes | yes | yes | no
5444 Arguments : none
5445
5446 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5447 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5448 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5449 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5450 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5451 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005452 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5453 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5454 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005455
5456 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5457 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5458 would not be logged.
5459
5460 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5461 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5462
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005463 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5464 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005465
5466
5467option forceclose
5468no option forceclose
5469 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005471 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005472 Arguments : none
5473
5474 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5475 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5476 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5477 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5478 global session times in the logs.
5479
5480 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005481 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005482 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005483
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005484 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5485 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5486 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5487
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005488 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5489 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005490
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005491 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5492 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5493
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005494 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005495
5496
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005497option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005498 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5500 yes | yes | yes | yes
5501 Arguments :
5502 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5503 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005504 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005505 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005506
5507 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5508 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5509 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5510 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5511 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5512 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5513 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005514 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5515 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5516 possible that the client has already brought one.
5517
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005518 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005519 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005520 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5521 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005522 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5523 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005524
5525 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5526 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5527 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5528 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5529 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5530 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5531 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5532
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005533 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5534 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5535 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5536 are under the control of the end-user.
5537
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005538 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005539 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5540 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005541 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5542 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5543 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005544
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005545 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005546 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5547 frontend www
5548 mode http
5549 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5550
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005551 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5552 backend www
5553 mode http
5554 option forwardfor header X-Client
5555
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005556 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005557 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005558
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005559
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005560option http-buffer-request
5561no option http-buffer-request
5562 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5564 yes | yes | yes | yes
5565 Arguments : none
5566
5567 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5568 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5569 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5570 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5571 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5572 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5573 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5574 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005575 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005576 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5577 default.
5578
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005579 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005580
5581
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005582option http-ignore-probes
5583no option http-ignore-probes
5584 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | yes | yes | no
5587 Arguments : none
5588
5589 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5590 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5591 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5592 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5593 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5594 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5595 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5596 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5597 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5598 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5599 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5600 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5601
5602 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5603 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5604 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5605 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5606 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5607 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5608 are often the only way to detect them.
5609
5610 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5611 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5612
5613 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5614
5615
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005616option http-keep-alive
5617no option http-keep-alive
5618 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5620 yes | yes | yes | yes
5621 Arguments : none
5622
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005623 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5624 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5625 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5626 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5627 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5628 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5629 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5630
5631 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5632 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005633 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5634 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5635 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5636 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5637 situations where this option may be useful :
5638
5639 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5640 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5641
5642 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5643 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5644
5645 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5646 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5647 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5648 request.
5649
5650 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5651 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005652 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5653 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5654 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005655
5656 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5657 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5658
5659 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5660 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5661 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5662 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5663 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5664 not set.
5665
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005666 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5667 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005668 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005669 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005670
5671 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005672 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5673 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005674
5675
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005676option http-no-delay
5677no option http-no-delay
5678 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5680 yes | yes | yes | yes
5681 Arguments : none
5682
5683 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5684 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5685 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5686 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5687 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5688 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5689 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5690 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5691 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5692 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5693 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5694 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5695 affected.
5696
5697 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5698 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5699 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5700 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5701 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5702 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5703 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5704 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5705 latency environments.
5706
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005707 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5708
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005709
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005710option http-pretend-keepalive
5711no option http-pretend-keepalive
5712 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5714 yes | yes | yes | yes
5715 Arguments : none
5716
5717 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5718 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5719 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5720 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5721 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5722 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5723 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5724 consider the response complete.
5725
5726 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5727 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5728 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5729 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5730 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5731 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5732
5733 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5734 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5735 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5736 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5737 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5738 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5739 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5740
5741 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5742 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005743 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005744 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5745 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005746
5747 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5748 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5749
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005750 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5751 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005752
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005753
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005754option http-server-close
5755no option http-server-close
5756 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5758 yes | yes | yes | yes
5759 Arguments : none
5760
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005761 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5762 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5763 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5764 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5765 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5766 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5767 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5768 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5769 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5770 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5771 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005772 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005773 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5774 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5775 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5776 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005777
5778 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5779 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5780 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5781 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005782 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5783 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005784
5785 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5786 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005787 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5788 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005789 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5790 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005791
5792 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5793 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5794
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005795 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005796 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5797 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005798
5799
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005800option http-tunnel
5801no option http-tunnel
5802 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5804 yes | yes | yes | yes
5805 Arguments : none
5806
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005807 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5808 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5809 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5810 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5811 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5812 "option http-tunnel".
5813
5814 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005815 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005816 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5817 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5818 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5819 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5820 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5821 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5822 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005823
5824 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5825 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5826
5827 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5828 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5829 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5830
5831
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005832option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005833no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005834 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5836 yes | yes | yes | no
5837 Arguments : none
5838
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005839 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005840 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5841 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5842 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5843 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5844 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5845 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5846
5847 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5848 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005849 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5850 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5851 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005852
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005853 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5854 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5855 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5856 front of an existing proxy.
5857
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005858 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5859
5860 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5861 http-server-close".
5862
5863
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005864option httpchk
5865option httpchk <uri>
5866option httpchk <method> <uri>
5867option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5868 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5870 yes | no | yes | yes
5871 Arguments :
5872 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5873 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5874 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5875 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5876 ones.
5877
5878 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5879 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5880 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5881
5882 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5883 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5884 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5885 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5886 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5887
5888 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5889 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5890 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5891 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5892 the lack of any response.
5893
5894 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5895
5896 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5897 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5898 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5899
5900 Examples :
5901 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5902 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5903 backend https_relay
5904 mode tcp
5905 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5906 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5907
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005908 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5909 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5910 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005911
5912
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005913option httpclose
5914no option httpclose
5915 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5917 yes | yes | yes | yes
5918 Arguments : none
5919
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005920 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5921 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5922 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5923 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005924 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005925 "option http-tunnel".
5926
5927 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5928 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5929 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5930 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5931 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5932 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5933 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5934 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005935
5936 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005937 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005938 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5939 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5940 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5941 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5942 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005943
5944 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5945 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005946 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5947 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005948 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5949 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005950
5951 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5952 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5953
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005954 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5955 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005956
5957
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005958option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005959 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5961 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005962 Arguments :
5963 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5964 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5965 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5966 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5967 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005968
5969 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5970 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5971 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5972 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5973 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5974 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5975 ports.
5976
5977 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5978
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005979 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5980 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005981
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005982 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005984 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005985
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005986
5987option http_proxy
5988no option http_proxy
5989 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5991 yes | yes | yes | yes
5992 Arguments : none
5993
5994 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5995 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5996 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5997 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5998 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5999
6000 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6001 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006002 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6003 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006004
6005 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6006 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6007
6008 Example :
6009 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6010 backend direct_forward
6011 option httpclose
6012 option http_proxy
6013
6014 See also : "option httpclose"
6015
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006016
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006017option independent-streams
6018no option independent-streams
6019 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6021 yes | yes | yes | yes
6022 Arguments : none
6023
6024 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6025 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6026 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6027 receive data or not.
6028
6029 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
6030 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6031 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6032 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6033 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6034 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6035 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6036 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6037 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6038 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6039 socket buffers.
6040
6041 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6042 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6043 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6044 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6045 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6046
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006047 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006048 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6049 deprecated.
6050
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006051 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006052
6053
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006054option ldap-check
6055 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6057 yes | no | yes | yes
6058 Arguments : none
6059
6060 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6061 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6062 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6063 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6064
6065 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6066 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6067
6068 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6069 configure it.
6070
6071 Example :
6072 option ldap-check
6073
6074 See also : "option httpchk"
6075
6076
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006077option external-check
6078 Use external processes for server health checks
6079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6080 yes | no | yes | yes
6081
6082 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6083 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6084 command".
6085
6086 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6087
6088 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6089
6090
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006091option log-health-checks
6092no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006093 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6095 yes | no | yes | yes
6096 Arguments : none
6097
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006098 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6099 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6100 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006101
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006102 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6103 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6104 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6105 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6106 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6107
6108 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
6109 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006110
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006111 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6112 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6113 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006114
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006115
6116option log-separate-errors
6117no option log-separate-errors
6118 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6120 yes | yes | yes | no
6121 Arguments : none
6122
6123 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6124 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6125 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6126 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6127 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6128 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6129 provides very important information.
6130
6131 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6132 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6133 error logs.
6134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006135 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006136 logging.
6137
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006138
6139option logasap
6140no option logasap
6141 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6143 yes | yes | yes | no
6144 Arguments : none
6145
6146 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6147 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6148 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6149 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6150 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6151 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6152 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006153 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006154 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6155 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6156
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006157 Examples :
6158 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6159 mode http
6160 option httplog
6161 option logasap
6162 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6163
6164 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6165 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6166 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6167 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006169 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006170 logging.
6171
6172
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006173option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006174 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6176 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006177 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006178 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6179 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006180 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006181
6182 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6183 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6184 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6185 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6186 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6187 in the MySQL table, like this :
6188
6189 USE mysql;
6190 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6191 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6192
6193 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6194 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6195 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6196 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6197 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6198 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6199 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6200 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6201 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6202
6203 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6204 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006205
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006206 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006207
6208 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6209 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6210 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6211 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006212 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6213 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006214
6215 See also: "option httpchk"
6216
6217
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006218option nolinger
6219no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006220 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006221 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6222 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006223 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006224
6225 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6226 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6227 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6228 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6229 connections.
6230
6231 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6232 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6233 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6234 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6235 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6236 this too.
6237
6238 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6239 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6240 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6241
6242 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6243 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6244 for servers.
6245
6246 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6247 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6248
6249
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006250option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6251 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6253 yes | yes | yes | yes
6254 Arguments :
6255 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6256 matching <network>
6257 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6258 header name.
6259
6260 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6261 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6262 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6263 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6264 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6265 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6266 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6267 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6268 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6269 possible that the client has already brought one.
6270
6271 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6272 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6273 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6274 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6275 header and requires different one.
6276
6277 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6278 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6279 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6280 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6281 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6282 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6283 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6284
6285 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6286 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6287 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6288 both are defined.
6289
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006290 Examples :
6291 # Original Destination address
6292 frontend www
6293 mode http
6294 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6295
6296 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6297 backend www
6298 mode http
6299 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6300
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006301 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6302 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006303
6304
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006305option persist
6306no option persist
6307 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6308 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6309 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006310 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006311
6312 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6313 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6314 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6315 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6316 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6317 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6318 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6319 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6320 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6321 redirected to another valid server.
6322
6323 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6324 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6325
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006326 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006327
6328
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006329option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6330 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6332 yes | no | yes | yes
6333 Arguments :
6334 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6335 PostgreSQL server.
6336
6337 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6338 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6339 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6340 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6341
6342 See also: "option httpchk"
6343
6344
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006345option prefer-last-server
6346no option prefer-last-server
6347 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6348 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6349 yes | no | yes | yes
6350 Arguments : none
6351
6352 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6353 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6354 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6355 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6356 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6357 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6358 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6359 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6360 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006361 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6362 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6363 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6364 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6365 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6366 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6367 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006368
6369 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6370 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6371
6372 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6373
6374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006375option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006376option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006377no option redispatch
6378 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6379 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6380 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006381 Arguments :
6382 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6383 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6384 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6385 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6386 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6387 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6388 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6389 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6390 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6391
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006392
6393 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6394 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6395 be able to access the service anymore.
6396
6397 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6398 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6399
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006400 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006401 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6402 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006404 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6405 "redisp" keywords.
6406
6407 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6408 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6409
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006410 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006411
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006412
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006413option redis-check
6414 Use redis health checks for server testing
6415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6416 yes | no | yes | yes
6417 Arguments : none
6418
6419 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6420 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6421 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6422 find the "+PONG" response message.
6423
6424 Example :
6425 option redis-check
6426
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006427 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006428
6429
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006430option smtpchk
6431option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6432 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6434 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006435 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006436 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6437 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6438 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6439
6440 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6441 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6442 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6443
6444 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6445 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6446 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6447 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6448 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6449 dead server.
6450
6451 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6452 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6453 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6454 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6455
6456 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6457 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6458 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6459 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006460 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006461
6462 Example :
6463 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6464
6465 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006467
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006468option socket-stats
6469no option socket-stats
6470
6471 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6473 yes | yes | yes | no
6474
6475 Arguments : none
6476
6477
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006478option splice-auto
6479no option splice-auto
6480 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6482 yes | yes | yes | yes
6483 Arguments : none
6484
6485 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6486 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6487 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6488 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006489 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006490 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6491 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6492 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6493 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6494
6495 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6496 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6497 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6498 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6499 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6500 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6501 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6502 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6503 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6504 keyword.
6505
6506 Example :
6507 option splice-auto
6508
6509 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6510 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6511
6512 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6513 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6514
6515
6516option splice-request
6517no option splice-request
6518 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6520 yes | yes | yes | yes
6521 Arguments : none
6522
6523 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006524 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006525 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6526 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6527 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6528 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6529
6530 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6531
6532 Example :
6533 option splice-request
6534
6535 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6536 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6537
6538 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6539 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6540
6541
6542option splice-response
6543no option splice-response
6544 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6546 yes | yes | yes | yes
6547 Arguments : none
6548
6549 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006550 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006551 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6552 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6553 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6554 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6555
6556 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6557
6558 Example :
6559 option splice-response
6560
6561 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6562 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6563
6564 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6565 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6566
6567
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006568option spop-check
6569 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6571 no | no | no | yes
6572 Arguments : none
6573
6574 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6575 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6576 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6577 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6578
6579 Example :
6580 option spop-check
6581
6582 See also : "option httpchk"
6583
6584
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006585option srvtcpka
6586no option srvtcpka
6587 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6589 yes | no | yes | yes
6590 Arguments : none
6591
6592 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6593 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6594 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6595 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6596
6597 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6598 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6599 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6600 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6601
6602 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6603 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6604 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6605 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6606 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6607
6608 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6609
6610 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6611 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6612 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6613
6614 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6615 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6616
6617 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6618
6619
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006620option ssl-hello-chk
6621 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6623 yes | no | yes | yes
6624 Arguments : none
6625
6626 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6627 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6628 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6629 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6630 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6631 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6632 hello message.
6633
6634 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6635 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6636 messages, which is appreciable.
6637
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006638 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6639 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6640 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006641
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006642 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6643
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006644
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006645option tcp-check
6646 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6648 yes | no | yes | yes
6649
6650 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6651 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6652
6653 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6654 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6655 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6656
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006657 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006658 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6659 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6660 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6661 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6662 only.
6663
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006664 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006665 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6666 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6667 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6668 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6669
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006670 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006671 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6672 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006673 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006674 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6675 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6676 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6677 the respective protocols.
6678 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6679 analysed.
6680
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006681 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6682 script.
6683
6684 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6685 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6686 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6687 The "comment" is of course optional.
6688
6689
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006690 Examples :
6691 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6692 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006693 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006694
6695 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6696 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006697 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006698
6699 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6700 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006701 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006702 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006703 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006704 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006705 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006706 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006707 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6708 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006709 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006710 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6711 tcp-check expect string +OK
6712
6713 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6714 (send many headers before analyzing)
6715 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006716 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006717 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6718 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6719 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6720 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006721 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006722
6723
6724 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6725
6726
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006727option tcp-smart-accept
6728no option tcp-smart-accept
6729 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6731 yes | yes | yes | no
6732 Arguments : none
6733
6734 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6735 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6736 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6737 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6738 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6739 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6740
6741 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6742 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6743 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6744 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6745
6746 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6747 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6748 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6749 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6750
6751 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6752 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6753 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6754
6755 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6756 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6757 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6758
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006759 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6760
6761
6762option tcp-smart-connect
6763no option tcp-smart-connect
6764 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6766 yes | no | yes | yes
6767 Arguments : none
6768
6769 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6770 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6771 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6772 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6773 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6774
6775 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6776 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6777 complex.
6778
6779 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6780 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6781 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6782
6783 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6784 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6785
6786 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6787
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006788
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006789option tcpka
6790 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6792 yes | yes | yes | yes
6793 Arguments : none
6794
6795 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6796 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6797 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6798 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6799
6800 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6801 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6802 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6803 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6804
6805 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6806 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6807 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6808 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6809 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6810
6811 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6812
6813 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6814 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6815 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6816 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6817 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6818 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6819 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6820 backends.
6821
6822 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6823
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006824
6825option tcplog
6826 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6828 yes | yes | yes | yes
6829 Arguments : none
6830
6831 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6832 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6833 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6834 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6835 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6836 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6837 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6838 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6839
6840 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6841
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006842 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006844 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006845
6846
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006847option transparent
6848no option transparent
6849 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006851 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006852 Arguments : none
6853
6854 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6855 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6856 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6857 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6858 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6859 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6860 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6861 appropriate server.
6862
6863 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6864 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6865
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006866 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006867 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006868
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006869
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006870external-check command <command>
6871 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6873 yes | no | yes | yes
6874
6875 Arguments :
6876 <command> is the external command to run
6877
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006878 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6879
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006880 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006881
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006882 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6883 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6884 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6885 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6886 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6887 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006888
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006889 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6890
6891 Environment variables :
6892 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6893 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6894
6895 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6896
6897 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6898
6899 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6900 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6901 for a UNIX socket).
6902
6903 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6904
6905 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6906
6907 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6908
6909 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6910
6911 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6912
6913 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6914 socket).
6915
6916 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6917 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6918
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006919 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6920 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6921 failed.
6922
6923 Example :
6924 external-check command /bin/true
6925
6926 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6927
6928
6929external-check path <path>
6930 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6932 yes | no | yes | yes
6933
6934 Arguments :
6935 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6936
6937 The default path is "".
6938
6939 Example :
6940 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6941
6942 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6943 "external-check command"
6944
6945
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006946persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006947persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006948 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6950 yes | no | yes | yes
6951 Arguments :
6952 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006953 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6954 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006955
6956 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6957 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6958 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6959 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6960 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6961 forwarded to this server.
6962
6963 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6964 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6965 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006966 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006967 a single "listen" section.
6968
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006969 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6970 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6971 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6972
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006973 Example :
6974 listen tse-farm
6975 bind :3389
6976 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6977 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6978 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6979 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6980 persist rdp-cookie
6981 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006982 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006983 balance rdp-cookie
6984 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6985 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6986
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006987 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6988 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006989
6990
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006991rate-limit sessions <rate>
6992 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6994 yes | yes | yes | no
6995 Arguments :
6996 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6997 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6998
6999 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7000 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7001 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7002 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7003 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7004 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7005
7006 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7007 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7008 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7009 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7010
7011 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7012 listen smtp
7013 mode tcp
7014 bind :25
7015 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007016 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007017
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007018 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7019 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7020 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007021
7022 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7023
7024
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007025redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7026redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7027redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007028 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7030 no | yes | yes | yes
7031
7032 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007033 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007034
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007035 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007036 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007037 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7038 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7039 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007040
7041 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7042 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7043 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7044 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7045 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007046 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7047 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7048 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7049 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007050
7051 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7052 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7053 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7054 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7055 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7056 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007057 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007058 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007059 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7060 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7061 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007062
7063 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007064 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7065 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7066 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007067 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007068 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7069 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7070 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7071 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007072
7073 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
7074 expected behaviour of a redirection :
7075
7076 - "drop-query"
7077 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7078 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7079 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7080 with a location-type redirect.
7081
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007082 - "append-slash"
7083 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7084 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7085 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7086 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7087
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007088 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7089 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7090 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7091 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7092 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7093 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7094 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7095
7096 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7097 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7098 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7099 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7100 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7101 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7102 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007103
7104 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7105 acl clear dst_port 80
7106 acl secure dst_port 8080
7107 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007108 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007109 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007110 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7111
7112 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007113 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7114 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7115 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007116 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007117
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007118 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7119 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7120 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7121
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007122 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007123 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007124
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007125 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007126 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7127 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7128 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007130 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007131
7132
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007133redisp (deprecated)
7134redispatch (deprecated)
7135 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7136 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7137 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007138 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007139
7140 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7141 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7142 be able to access the service anymore.
7143
7144 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7145 redistribute them to a working server.
7146
7147 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7148 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7149 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007151 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7152 "option redispatch" instead.
7153
7154 See also : "option redispatch"
7155
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007156
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007157reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007158 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7160 no | yes | yes | yes
7161 Arguments :
7162 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7163 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007164 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007165
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007166 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7167 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7168
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007169 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7170 the last header of an HTTP request.
7171
7172 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7173 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7174 responses.
7175
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007176 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7177 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7178 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7179
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007180 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7181 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007182
7183
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007184reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7185reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007186 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7188 no | yes | yes | yes
7189 Arguments :
7190 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7191 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7192 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7193 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7194 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7195 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7196 ignores case.
7197
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007198 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7199 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7200
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007201 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7202 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7203 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7204 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007205 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007206
7207 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7208 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7209
7210 Example :
7211 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7212 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7213 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7214
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007215 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7216 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007217
7218
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007219reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7220reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007221 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7223 no | yes | yes | yes
7224 Arguments :
7225 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7226 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7227 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7228 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7229 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7230 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7231
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007232 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7233 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7234
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007235 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7236 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7237 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7238 next servers.
7239
7240 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7241 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7242 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7243
7244 Example :
7245 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7246 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7247 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7248
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007249 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7250 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007251
7252
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007253reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7254reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007255 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7257 no | yes | yes | yes
7258 Arguments :
7259 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7260 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7261 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7262 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7263 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7264 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7265 case.
7266
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007267 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7268 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7269
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007270 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7271 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7272 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7273 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007274 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007275
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007276 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007277 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007278 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007279
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007280 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7281 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7282
7283 Example :
7284 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7285 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7286 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7287
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007288 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7289 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007290
7291
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007292reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7293reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007294 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7296 no | yes | yes | yes
7297 Arguments :
7298 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7299 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7300 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7301 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7302 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7303 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7304 case.
7305
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007306 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7307 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7308
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007309 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7310 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7311 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7312 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7313
7314 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7315 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7316
7317 Example :
7318 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7319 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7320 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7321 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7322
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007323 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7324 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007325
7326
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007327reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7328reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007329 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7331 no | yes | yes | yes
7332 Arguments :
7333 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7334 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7335 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7336 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7337 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7338 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7339
7340 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7341 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7342 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7343 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007344 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007345
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007346 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7347 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7348
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007349 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7350 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7351 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7352
7353 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7354 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7355 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7356 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7357 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7358
7359 Example :
7360 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007361 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007362 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7363 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7364
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007365 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7366 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007367
7368
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007369reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7370reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007371 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7373 no | yes | yes | yes
7374 Arguments :
7375 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7376 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7377 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7378 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7379 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7380 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7381 ignores case.
7382
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007383 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7384 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7385
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007386 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7387 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007388 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7389 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7390 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007391 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7392 not set.
7393
7394 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7395 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7396 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7397 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7398 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7399
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007400 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007401 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7402 # block all others.
7403 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7404 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7405
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007406 # block bad guys
7407 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7408 reqitarpit . if badguys
7409
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007410 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7411 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007412
7413
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007414retries <value>
7415 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7416 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7417 yes | no | yes | yes
7418 Arguments :
7419 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7420 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7421 default value is 3.
7422
7423 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7424 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7425 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7426
7427 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007428 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7429 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007430
7431 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7432 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7433
7434 See also : "option redispatch"
7435
7436
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007437rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007438 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7440 no | yes | yes | yes
7441 Arguments :
7442 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7443 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007444 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007445
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007446 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7447 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7448
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007449 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7450 the last header of an HTTP response.
7451
7452 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7453 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7454 responses.
7455
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007456 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7457 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007458
7459
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007460rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7461rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007462 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7464 no | yes | yes | yes
7465 Arguments :
7466 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7467 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7468 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7469 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7470 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7471 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7472 ignores case.
7473
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007474 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7475 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7476
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007477 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7478 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007479 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007480 client.
7481
7482 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7483 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7484 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7485
7486 Example :
7487 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007488 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007489
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007490 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7491 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007492
7493
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007494rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7495rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007496 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7498 no | yes | yes | yes
7499 Arguments :
7500 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7501 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7502 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7503 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7504 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7505 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7506 ignores case.
7507
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007508 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7509 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7510
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007511 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7512 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7513 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7514 case-sensitive.
7515
7516 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007517 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7518 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7519 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007520
7521 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7522 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7523
7524 Example :
7525 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7526 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7527
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007528 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7529 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007530
7531
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007532rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7533rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007534 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7536 no | yes | yes | yes
7537 Arguments :
7538 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7539 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7540 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7541 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7542 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7543 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7544 ignores case.
7545
7546 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7547 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7548 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7549 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007550 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007551
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007552 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7553 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7554
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007555 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7556 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7557 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7558
7559 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7560 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7561 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7562 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7563 are not case-sensitive.
7564
7565 Example :
7566 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7567 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7568
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007569 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7570 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007571
7572
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007573server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007574 Declare a server in a backend
7575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7576 no | no | yes | yes
7577 Arguments :
7578 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007579 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007580 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007581
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007582 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7583 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7584 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7585 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007586 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7587 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7588 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7589 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7590 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007591 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7592 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7593 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7594 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7595 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7596 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7597 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007598 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007599 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7600 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007601 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7602 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007603
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007604 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007605 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7606 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7607 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7608 adding this value to the client's port.
7609
7610 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7611 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007612 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007613
7614 Examples :
7615 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7616 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007617 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007618 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7619 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7620 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007621
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007622 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7623 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7624 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7625 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7626 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7627
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007628 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7629 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007630
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007631server-state-file-name [<file>]
7632 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7633 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7634 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7635 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7636 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7637 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7638
7639 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7640 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7641
7642 global
7643 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7644
7645 backend bk
7646 load-server-state-from-file
7647
7648 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7649 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007650
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007651server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7652 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7653 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7655 no | no | yes | yes
7656
7657 Arguments:
7658 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7659
7660 <num | range>
7661 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7662 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7663 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7664 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7665
7666 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7667
7668 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7669
7670 <params*>
7671 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7672 keyword.
7673
7674 Examples:
7675 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7676 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7677 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7678
7679 # or
7680 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7681
7682 # would be equivalent to:
7683 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7684 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7685 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7686
7687
7688
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007689source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007690source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007691source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007692 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7694 yes | no | yes | yes
7695 Arguments :
7696 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7697 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007698
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007699 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007700 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7701 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7702 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7703 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7704 supported prefixes are :
7705 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7706 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7707 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007708 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007709 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7710 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007711
7712 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7713 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007714 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7715 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7716 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007717
7718 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7719 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7720 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7721 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7722 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7723 <addr>.
7724
7725 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7726 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7727 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7728 port.
7729
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007730 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7731 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7732 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7733 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007734 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007735 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7736 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7737 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7738 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7739 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7740 HTTP header.
7741
7742 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7743 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007744 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007745 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7746 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7747 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7748 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7749 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7750 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7751 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7752
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007753 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7754 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7755 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7756 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7757 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7758 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7759
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007760 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7761 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7762 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7763 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7764
7765 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7766 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7767 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7768 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7769 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7770 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7771
7772 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7773 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7774 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7775 there are two methods :
7776
7777 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7778 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7779 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7780 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7781 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7782 of the client ranges may be used.
7783
7784 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7785 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7786 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7787 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7788 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7789 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7790 same session.
7791
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007792 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7793 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7794 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007795 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007796
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007797 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7798
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007799 Examples :
7800 backend private
7801 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7802 source 192.168.1.200
7803
7804 backend transparent_ssl1
7805 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7806 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7807
7808 backend transparent_ssl2
7809 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7810 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7811 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7812
7813 backend transparent_ssl3
7814 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7815 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7816 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7817
7818 backend transparent_smtp
7819 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7820 # with Tproxy version 4.
7821 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7822
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007823 backend transparent_http
7824 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7825 # proxy.
7826 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007828 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007829 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7830
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007831
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007832srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7833 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7835 yes | no | yes | yes
7836 Arguments :
7837 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7838 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7839 as explained at the top of this document.
7840
7841 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7842 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7843 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7844 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7845 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7846 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7847 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7848
7849 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7850 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7851 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7852 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7853 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007854 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007855 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007856 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007857
7858 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7859 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7860 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7861 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7862 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7863 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7864
7865 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7866 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7867
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007868 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7869 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007870
7871
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007872stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7873 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007875 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007876
7877 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7878 matched.
7879
7880 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7881 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7882
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007883 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7884 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7885 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7886
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007887 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7888 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7889 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7890 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007891
7892 Example :
7893 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7894 backend stats_localhost
7895 stats enable
7896 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7897
7898 Example :
7899 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7900 backend stats_auth
7901 stats enable
7902 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7903 stats admin if TRUE
7904
7905 Example :
7906 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7907 userlist stats-auth
7908 group admin users admin
7909 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7910 group readonly users haproxy
7911 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7912
7913 backend stats_auth
7914 stats enable
7915 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7916 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7917 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7918 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7919
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007920 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7921 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7922 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007923
7924
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007925stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7926 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007928 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007929 Arguments :
7930 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7931
7932 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7933
7934 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7935 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7936 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7937 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7938 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7939 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7940
7941 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7942 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7943 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007944 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007945
7946 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7947 report using "stats scope".
7948
7949 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7950 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7951 unobvious parameters.
7952
7953 Example :
7954 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7955 backend public_www
7956 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7957 stats enable
7958 stats hide-version
7959 stats scope .
7960 stats uri /admin?stats
7961 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7962 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7963 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7964
7965 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7966 backend private_monitoring
7967 stats enable
7968 stats uri /admin?stats
7969 stats refresh 5s
7970
7971 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7972
7973
7974stats enable
7975 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007977 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007978 Arguments : none
7979
7980 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7981 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7982 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7983 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7984 - stats auth : no authentication
7985 - stats scope : no restriction
7986
7987 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7988 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7989 unobvious parameters.
7990
7991 Example :
7992 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7993 backend public_www
7994 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7995 stats enable
7996 stats hide-version
7997 stats scope .
7998 stats uri /admin?stats
7999 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8000 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8001 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8002
8003 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8004 backend private_monitoring
8005 stats enable
8006 stats uri /admin?stats
8007 stats refresh 5s
8008
8009 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8010
8011
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008012stats hide-version
8013 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008015 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008016 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008017
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008018 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8019 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8020 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8021 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8022 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8023 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008025 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8026 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8027 unobvious parameters.
8028
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008029 Example :
8030 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8031 backend public_www
8032 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008033 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008034 stats hide-version
8035 stats scope .
8036 stats uri /admin?stats
8037 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8038 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8039 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008040
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008041 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8042 backend private_monitoring
8043 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008044 stats uri /admin?stats
8045 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008046
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008047 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008048
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008049
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008050stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8051 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8052 Access control for statistics
8053
8054 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8055 no | no | yes | yes
8056
8057 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8058 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8059 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8060 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8061 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8062 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8063
8064 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8065 instance.
8066
8067 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8068 about ACL usage.
8069
8070
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008071stats realm <realm>
8072 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008074 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008075 Arguments :
8076 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8077 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8078 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8079
8080 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8081 using a backslash ('\').
8082
8083 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8084 only related to authentication.
8085
8086 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8087 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8088 unobvious parameters.
8089
8090 Example :
8091 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8092 backend public_www
8093 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8094 stats enable
8095 stats hide-version
8096 stats scope .
8097 stats uri /admin?stats
8098 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8099 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8100 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8101
8102 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8103 backend private_monitoring
8104 stats enable
8105 stats uri /admin?stats
8106 stats refresh 5s
8107
8108 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8109
8110
8111stats refresh <delay>
8112 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008114 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008115 Arguments :
8116 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8117 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8118 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8119 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8120 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8121 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8122
8123 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8124 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8125 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8126 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8127
8128 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8129 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8130 unobvious parameters.
8131
8132 Example :
8133 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8134 backend public_www
8135 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8136 stats enable
8137 stats hide-version
8138 stats scope .
8139 stats uri /admin?stats
8140 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8141 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8142 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8143
8144 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8145 backend private_monitoring
8146 stats enable
8147 stats uri /admin?stats
8148 stats refresh 5s
8149
8150 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8151
8152
8153stats scope { <name> | "." }
8154 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008156 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008157 Arguments :
8158 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8159 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8160 section in which the statement appears.
8161
8162 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8163 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8164 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8165 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8166 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8167 exists.
8168
8169 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8170 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8171 unobvious parameters.
8172
8173 Example :
8174 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8175 backend public_www
8176 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8177 stats enable
8178 stats hide-version
8179 stats scope .
8180 stats uri /admin?stats
8181 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8182 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8183 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8184
8185 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8186 backend private_monitoring
8187 stats enable
8188 stats uri /admin?stats
8189 stats refresh 5s
8190
8191 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8192
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008193
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008194stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008195 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008197 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008198
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008199 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008200 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8201
8202 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8203 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8204
8205 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8206 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008207 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008208
8209 Example :
8210 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8211 backend private_monitoring
8212 stats enable
8213 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8214 stats uri /admin?stats
8215 stats refresh 5s
8216
8217 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8218 global section.
8219
8220
8221stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008222 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8224 yes | yes | yes | yes
8225 Arguments : none
8226
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008227 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008228 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8229 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8230 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8231 - IP (socket, server)
8232 - cookie (backend, server)
8233
8234 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8235 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008236 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008237
8238 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8239
8240
8241stats show-node [ <name> ]
8242 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008244 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008245 Arguments:
8246 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8247 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8248
8249 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8250 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008251 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008252
8253 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8254 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8255 unobvious parameters.
8256
8257 Example:
8258 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8259 backend private_monitoring
8260 stats enable
8261 stats show-node Europe-1
8262 stats uri /admin?stats
8263 stats refresh 5s
8264
8265 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8266 section.
8267
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008268
8269stats uri <prefix>
8270 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008272 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008273 Arguments :
8274 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8275 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8276 query string.
8277
8278 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8279 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8280 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8281 possible to reach it in the application.
8282
8283 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008284 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008285 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8286 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8287 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8288 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8289
8290 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8291 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8292 an address or a port to statistics only.
8293
8294 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8295 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8296 unobvious parameters.
8297
8298 Example :
8299 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8300 backend public_www
8301 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8302 stats enable
8303 stats hide-version
8304 stats scope .
8305 stats uri /admin?stats
8306 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8307 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8308 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8309
8310 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8311 backend private_monitoring
8312 stats enable
8313 stats uri /admin?stats
8314 stats refresh 5s
8315
8316 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8317
8318
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008319stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8320 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008322 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008323
8324 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008325 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008326 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8327 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8328 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8329
8330 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8331 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8332 the "stick-table" statement.
8333
8334 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8335 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8336 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8337 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8338 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8339
8340 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8341 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8342 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8343 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8344 transformation rules.
8345
8346 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8347 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8348 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8349 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8350 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8351 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8352 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8353
8354 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8355 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8356 ACL based conditions.
8357
8358 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8359 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8360 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8361 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8362
8363 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8364 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8365 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8366 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8367
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008368 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8369 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8370 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8371
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008372 Example :
8373 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8374 # last 30 minutes
8375 backend pop
8376 mode tcp
8377 balance roundrobin
8378 stick store-request src
8379 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8380 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8381 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8382
8383 backend smtp
8384 mode tcp
8385 balance roundrobin
8386 stick match src table pop
8387 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8388 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8389
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008390 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008391 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008392
8393
8394stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8395 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8397 no | no | yes | yes
8398
8399 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8400 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8401 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8402 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8403
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008404 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8405 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8406 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8407
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008408 Examples :
8409 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008410 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008411
8412 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8413 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8414 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8415
8416
8417 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8418 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8419 backend http
8420 mode http
8421 balance roundrobin
8422 stick on src table https
8423 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8424 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8425 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8426
8427 backend https
8428 mode tcp
8429 balance roundrobin
8430 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8431 stick on src
8432 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8433 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8434
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008435 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008436
8437
8438stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8439 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8441 no | no | yes | yes
8442
8443 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008444 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008445 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8446 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8447 server is selected.
8448
8449 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8450 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8451 the "stick-table" statement.
8452
8453 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8454 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8455 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8456 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8457 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8458 address.
8459
8460 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8461 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8462 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8463 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8464 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8465 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8466 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8467 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8468 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8469 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8470
8471 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8472 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8473 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8474 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8475 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8476 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8477 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8478
8479 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8480 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8481 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8482 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8483
8484 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8485 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8486 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8487 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8488 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8489 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008490 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8491 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8492 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8493 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8494 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8495 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008496
8497 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8498 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8499 the request.
8500
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008501 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8502 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8503 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8504
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008505 Example :
8506 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8507 # last 30 minutes
8508 backend pop
8509 mode tcp
8510 balance roundrobin
8511 stick store-request src
8512 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8513 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8514 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8515
8516 backend smtp
8517 mode tcp
8518 balance roundrobin
8519 stick match src table pop
8520 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8521 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8522
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008523 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008524 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008525
8526
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008527stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008528 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8529 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008530 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008532 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008533
8534 Arguments :
8535 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8536 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8537 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8538 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8539
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008540 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8541 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8542 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8543 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8544
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008545 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8546 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8547 instance.
8548
8549 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8550 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8551 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8552 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8553 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8554 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008555 to 32 characters.
8556
8557 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8558 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8559 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008560 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008561 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8562 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008563
8564 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008565 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8566 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008567 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8568 increase.
8569
8570 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008571 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8572 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8573 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008574
8575 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8576 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8577 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8578 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8579 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8580 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8581 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8582 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8583 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8584 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8585 parameter (see below).
8586
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008587 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8588 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8589 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8590 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8591 soft restart.
8592
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008593 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8594 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008595
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008596 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8597 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8598 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8599 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008600 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008601 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008602 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8603 if not expiration delay is specified.
8604
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008605 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8606 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8607 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8608 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008609 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8610 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8611 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8612 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8613 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8614 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8615 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8616 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8617 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8618 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8619 types and their arguments.
8620
8621 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8622 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8623 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8624 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8625
8626 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8627 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8628 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8629 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8630
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008631 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8632 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8633 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8634 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8635 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8636 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8637
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008638 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8639 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8640 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8641 they were received.
8642
8643 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8644 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8645 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8646 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8647 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8648
8649 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8650 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8651 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8652 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8653 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8654
8655 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8656 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8657 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8658
8659 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8660 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8661 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8662 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8663 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8664
8665 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8666 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8667 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8668 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8669 the client side.
8670
8671 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8672 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8673 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8674 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8675 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8676 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8677 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8678
8679 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8680 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8681 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8682 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8683 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8684 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8685 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8686
8687 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8688 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8689 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8690 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8691 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8692 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8693
8694 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8695 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8696 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8697 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8698
8699 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8700 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8701 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8702 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8703 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8704 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8705 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8706 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8707 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8708 recommended for better fairness.
8709
8710 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8711 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8712 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8713 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8714
8715 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8716 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8717 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8718 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8719 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8720 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8721 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8722 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8723 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8724 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008725
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008726 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8727 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008728 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8729 reference it.
8730
8731 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8732 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008733 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8734 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8735 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008736
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008737 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8738 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8739 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8740 something that can be ignored.
8741
8742 Example:
8743 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8744 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8745 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8746 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8747
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008748 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008749 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008750
8751
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008752stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008753 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8755 no | no | yes | yes
8756
8757 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008758 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008759 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8760 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8761 server is selected.
8762
8763 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8764 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8765 the "stick-table" statement.
8766
8767 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8768 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8769 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8770 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8771
8772 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8773 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8774 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8775 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8776 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8777 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008778 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008779 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8780 rules.
8781
8782 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8783 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8784 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8785 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8786 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8787 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8788 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8789
8790 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8791 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8792 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8793 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8794
8795 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8796 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8797 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8798 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8799 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8800 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008801 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8802 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8803 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8804 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8805 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8806 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8807 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8808 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8809 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008810
8811 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8812
8813 Example :
8814 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8815 backend https
8816 mode tcp
8817 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008818 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008819 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008820
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008821 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8822 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8823
8824 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8825 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8826 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8827
8828 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8829 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008830
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008831 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8832 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8833 # at offset 44.
8834
8835 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8836 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8837
8838 # Learn on response if server hello.
8839 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008840
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008841 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8842 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8843
8844 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8845 extraction.
8846
8847
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008848tcp-check connect [params*]
8849 Opens a new connection
8850 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8851 no | no | yes | yes
8852
8853 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8854 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8855 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8856
8857 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8858 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8859 of the sequence.
8860
8861 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8862 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8863 do.
8864
8865 Parameters :
8866 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8867 use the TCP connection.
8868
8869 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8870 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8871 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8872
8873 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8874
8875 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8876
8877 Examples:
8878 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8879 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8880 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8881 option tcp-check
8882 tcp-check connect
8883 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8884 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8885 tcp-check send \r\n
8886 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8887 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8888 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8889 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8890 tcp-check send \r\n
8891 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8892 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8893
8894 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8895 option tcp-check
8896 tcp-check connect port 110
8897 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8898 tcp-check connect port 143
8899 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8900 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8901
8902 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8903
8904
8905tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8906 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8907 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8908 no | no | yes | yes
8909
8910 Arguments :
8911 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8912 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8913 binary.
8914 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8915 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8916 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8917
8918 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8919 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8920 with the usual backslash ('\').
8921 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8922 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8923 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8924 used upper or lower case.
8925
8926
8927 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8928
8929 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8930 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8931 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8932 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8933 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8934 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8935 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8936 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8937
8938 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8939 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8940 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8941 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8942 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8943 expression.
8944
8945 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8946 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8947 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8948 this exact hexadecimal string.
8949 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8950
8951 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8952 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8953 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8954 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8955 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8956 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8957 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8958 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8959 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8960 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8961 the null character.
8962
8963 Examples :
8964 # perform a POP check
8965 option tcp-check
8966 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8967
8968 # perform an IMAP check
8969 option tcp-check
8970 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8971
8972 # look for the redis master server
8973 option tcp-check
8974 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008975 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008976 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8977 tcp-check expect string role:master
8978 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8979 tcp-check expect string +OK
8980
8981
8982 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8983 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8984
8985
8986tcp-check send <data>
8987 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8988 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8989 no | no | yes | yes
8990
8991 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8992 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8993
8994 Examples :
8995 # look for the redis master server
8996 option tcp-check
8997 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8998 tcp-check expect string role:master
8999
9000 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9001 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9002
9003
9004tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
9005 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
9006 tcp health check
9007 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9008 no | no | yes | yes
9009
9010 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9011 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9012 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
9013 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9014 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9015 hexadecimal string.
9016 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9017
9018 Examples :
9019 # redis check in binary
9020 option tcp-check
9021 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9022 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9023
9024
9025 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9026 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9027
9028
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009029tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9030 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9032 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009033 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009034 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9035 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009036
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009037 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009038
9039 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9040 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009041 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9042 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9043 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9044 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9045 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9046 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009047
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009048 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9049 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9050 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9051 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009052
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009053 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009054 - accept :
9055 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9056 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9057 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009058
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009059 - reject :
9060 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9061 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9062 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9063 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9064 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9065 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9066 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9067 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9068 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9069 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9070 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009071 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009072
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009073 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9074 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9075 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9076 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9077 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9078 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9079 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9080 hosts.
9081
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009082 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9083 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9084 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9085 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9086 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9087 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9088 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9089 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9090
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009091 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9092 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9093 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9094 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9095 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9096 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9097 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9098 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9099 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009100 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9101 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009102
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009103 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009104 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009105 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009106 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009107 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9108 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009109 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009110 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9111 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9112 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9113 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9114 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009115
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009116 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009117 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009118 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009119 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
9120 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9121 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9122 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009123
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009124 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9125 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9126 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9127 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009128
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009129 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9130 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9131 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9132 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9133 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009134 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9135 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9136 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9137 layer7 information is extracted.
9138
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009139 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9140 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9141 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9142 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9143 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009144
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009145 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9146 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9147 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9148 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9149
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009150 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9151 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9152 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9153 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9154 continues.
9155
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009156 - set-src <expr> :
9157 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9158 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9159 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9160 set-src"
9161
9162 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9163 followed by some converters.
9164
9165 Example:
9166
9167 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9168
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009169 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9170 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009171
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009172 - set-src-port <expr> :
9173 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9174 expression.
9175
9176 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9177 followed by some converters.
9178
9179 Example:
9180
9181 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9182
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009183 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9184 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9185 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009186
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009187 - set-dst <expr> :
9188 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9189 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9190 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9191 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9192 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9193
9194 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9195 followed by some converters.
9196
9197 Example:
9198
9199 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9200 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9201
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009202 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9203 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9204
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009205 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9206 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9207 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9208 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9209
9210
9211 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9212 followed by some converters.
9213
9214 Example:
9215
9216 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9217
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009218 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9219 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9220 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9221
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009222 - "silent-drop" :
9223 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9224 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9225 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9226 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9227 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9228 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9229 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9230 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9231 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9232 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9233 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9234 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9235 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9236 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9237 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9238 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9239
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009240 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9241 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9242 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009244 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9245 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9246 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009247
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009248 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009249 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009250 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009251
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009252 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9253 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9254 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009255
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009256 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009257 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9258 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009259
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009260 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9261
9262 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9263
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009264 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9265
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009266 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009267
9268
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009269tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9270 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009272 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009273 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009274 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9275 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009276
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009277 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009279 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9280 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9281 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9282 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9283 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009284
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009285 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9286 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9287 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9288 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009289 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9290 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9291 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9292 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9293 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9294 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009295 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009296 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009297
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009298 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9299 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9300 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9301 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009302
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009303 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009304 - accept : the request is accepted
9305 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9306 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009307 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009308 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009309 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009310 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009311 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009312 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009313 - send-spoe-group <engin-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009314
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009315 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9316 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009317
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009318 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9319 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9320 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9321 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9322 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9323 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009324
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009325 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009326 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9327 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009328
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009329 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009330 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9331 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9332 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9333 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009334 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9335 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9336 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009337
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009338 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009339 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9340 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9341 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009342
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009343 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009344 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9345 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009346
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009347 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9348 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009349 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009350 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9351 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009352 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009353 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009354 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009355 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9356 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009357 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009358 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9359 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009360
9361 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9362 followed by some converters.
9363
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009364 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9365 <var-name>.
9366
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009367 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9368 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9369 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9370 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9371 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9372
9373 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9374
9375 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9376
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009377 Example:
9378
9379 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009380 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009381
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009382 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009383 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9384 # and reject everything else.
9385 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9386 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009387 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009388 tcp-request content reject
9389
9390 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009391 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9392 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9393 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009394 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009395
9396 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9397 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9398 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009399 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009400 tcp-request content reject
9401
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009402 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009403 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009404 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009405 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009406 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9407 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009408
9409 Example:
9410 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9411 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009412 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009413
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009414 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009415 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009416
9417 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009418 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009419 # protecting all our sites
9420 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009421 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9422 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009423 ...
9424 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9425
9426 backend http_dynamic
9427 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009428 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009429 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009430 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009431 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009432 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009433 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009434
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009435 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009436
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009437 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9438 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009439
9440
9441tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9442 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009444 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009445 Arguments :
9446 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9447 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9448 as explained at the top of this document.
9449
9450 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9451 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9452 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9453 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9454 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9455
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009456 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9457 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9458 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9459 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9460
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009461 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9462 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009463 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009464 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009465 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9466 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9467 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9468 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009469
9470 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9471 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9472 it pass through unaffected.
9473
9474 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9475 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9476 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009477 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009478 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9479 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009480 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9481 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9482 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009483
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009484 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009485 "timeout client".
9486
9487
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009488tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9489 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9491 no | no | yes | yes
9492 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009493 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9494 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009495
9496 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9497
9498 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9499 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9500 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009501 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9502 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009503
9504 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9505
9506 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9507 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9508 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9509 inserted.
9510
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009511 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009512 - accept :
9513 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9514 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9515 the rules evaluation.
9516
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009517 - close :
9518 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9519 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9520 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9521 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9522 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9523 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009524 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009525 protocols.
9526
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009527 - reject :
9528 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9529 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009530 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009531
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009532 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9533 Sets a variable.
9534
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009535 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9536 Unsets a variable.
9537
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009538 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9539 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9540 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9541 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9542
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009543 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9544 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9545 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9546 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9547 continues.
9548
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009549 - "silent-drop" :
9550 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9551 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9552 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9553 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9554 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9555 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9556 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9557 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9558 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9559 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9560 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9561 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9562 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9563 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9564 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9565 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9566
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009567 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9568 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9569
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009570 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9571 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9572 for changing the default action to a reject.
9573
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009574 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9575 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9576 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9577 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009578 period.
9579
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009580 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9581 declared inline.
9582
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009583 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9584 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009585 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009586 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9587 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009588 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009589 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009590 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009591 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9592 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009593 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009594 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9595 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009596
9597 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9598 followed by some converters.
9599
9600 Example:
9601
9602 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9603
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009604 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9605 <var-name>.
9606
9607 Example:
9608
9609 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9610
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009611 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9612 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9613 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9614 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9615 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9616
9617 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9618
9619 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9620
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009621 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9622
9623 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9624
9625
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009626tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9627 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9629 no | yes | yes | no
9630 Arguments :
9631 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9632 below.
9633
9634 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9635
9636 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9637 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9638 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9639 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9640 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9641 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9642 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9643 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9644 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9645 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9646 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9647 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9648 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9649 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9650 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9651 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9652 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9653 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9654 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9655 instead.
9656
9657 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9658 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9659 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9660 rules which may be inserted.
9661
9662 Several types of actions are supported :
9663 - accept : the request is accepted
9664 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9665 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9666 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9667 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9668 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009669 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009670 - silent-drop
9671
9672 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9673 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9674 sections for a complete description.
9675
9676 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9677 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9678 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9679
9680 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9681 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9682 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9683 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9684 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9685
9686 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9687 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9688
9689 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9690 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9691 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9692
9693 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9694 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9695 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9696
9697 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9698 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9699 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9700
9701 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9702 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9703 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9704
9705 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9706
9707 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9708
9709
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009710tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9711 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9713 no | no | yes | yes
9714 Arguments :
9715 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9716 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9717 as explained at the top of this document.
9718
9719 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9720
9721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009722timeout check <timeout>
9723 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9724 established.
9725
9726 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9727 yes | no | yes | yes
9728 Arguments:
9729 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9730 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9731 as explained at the top of this document.
9732
9733 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9734 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9735 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9736 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009737 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9738 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9739 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009740
9741 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9742 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9743
9744 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9745 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009746 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009747
9748 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9749 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9750 forget about it.
9751
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009752 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9753 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009754
9755
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009756timeout client <timeout>
9757timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9758 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9760 yes | yes | yes | no
9761 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009762 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009763 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9764 as explained at the top of this document.
9765
9766 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9767 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9768 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009769 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9770 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9771 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9772 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009773 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9774 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9775 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009776 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009777 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009778 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9779 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009780 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9781 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009782
9783 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9784 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9785 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9786 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9787 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9788 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9789
9790 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9791 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9792 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9793
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009794 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9795 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009796
9797
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009798timeout client-fin <timeout>
9799 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9801 yes | yes | yes | no
9802 Arguments :
9803 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9804 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9805 as explained at the top of this document.
9806
9807 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9808 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9809 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9810 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9811 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9812 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9813 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9814 down in one direction.
9815
9816 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9817 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9818 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9819
9820 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9821
9822
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009823timeout connect <timeout>
9824timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9825 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9827 yes | no | yes | yes
9828 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009829 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009830 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9831 as explained at the top of this document.
9832
9833 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009834 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009835 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009836 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009837 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9838 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009839
9840 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9841 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9842 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9843 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9844 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9845 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9846
9847 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9848 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9849 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9850
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009851 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9852 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009853
9854
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009855timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9856 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9858 yes | yes | yes | yes
9859 Arguments :
9860 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9861 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9862 as explained at the top of this document.
9863
9864 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9865 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9866 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9867 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9868 once the request has started to present itself.
9869
9870 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9871 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9872 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9873 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9874 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9875
9876 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9877 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9878 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9879 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9880
9881 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9882 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9883 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9884 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9885 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009886 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009887
9888 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9889 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9890 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9891 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9892
9893 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9894
9895
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009896timeout http-request <timeout>
9897 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009899 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009900 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009901 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009902 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9903 as explained at the top of this document.
9904
9905 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9906 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9907 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9908 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9909 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9910 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9911 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009912 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9913 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9914 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9915 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9916 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009917 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9918 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009919
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009920 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9921 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9922 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9923 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9924 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009925 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009926
9927 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9928 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9929 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9930 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9931 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9932
9933 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009934 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9935 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9936 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009937
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009938 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009939 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009940
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009941
9942timeout queue <timeout>
9943 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9945 yes | no | yes | yes
9946 Arguments :
9947 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9948 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9949 as explained at the top of this document.
9950
9951 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9952 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9953 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9954 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9955 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9956
9957 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9958 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9959 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9960 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9961
9962 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9963
9964
9965timeout server <timeout>
9966timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9967 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9969 yes | no | yes | yes
9970 Arguments :
9971 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9972 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9973 as explained at the top of this document.
9974
9975 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9976 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9977 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9978 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9979 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9980 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9981 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9982
9983 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9984 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9985 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9986 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9987 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009988 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009989 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009990 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9991 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9992 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9993 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009994
9995 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9996 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9997 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9998 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9999 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10000 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10001
10002 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10003 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10004 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10005
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010006 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010007
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010008
10009timeout server-fin <timeout>
10010 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10012 yes | no | yes | yes
10013 Arguments :
10014 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10015 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10016 as explained at the top of this document.
10017
10018 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10019 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10020 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10021 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10022 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10023 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10024 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10025 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10026 situations, it should not be needed.
10027
10028 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10029 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10030 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10031
10032 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10033
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010034
10035timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010036 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10038 yes | yes | yes | yes
10039 Arguments :
10040 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10041 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10042 as explained at the top of this document.
10043
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010044 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10045 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10046 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10047 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010048
10049 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10050 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10051 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10052 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010053 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010054
10055 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10056
10057
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010058timeout tunnel <timeout>
10059 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10061 yes | no | yes | yes
10062 Arguments :
10063 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10064 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10065 as explained at the top of this document.
10066
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010067 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010068 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10069 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10070 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
10071 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
10072 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
10073 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10074 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10075 specified.
10076
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010077 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10078 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10079 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10080 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10081 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10082 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10083 state.
10084
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010085 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10086 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10087 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10088 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
10089 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
10090
10091 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10092 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10093 forget about it.
10094
10095 Example :
10096 defaults http
10097 option http-server-close
10098 timeout connect 5s
10099 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010100 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010101 timeout server 30s
10102 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10103
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010104 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010105
10106
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010107transparent (deprecated)
10108 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010110 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010111 Arguments : none
10112
10113 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10114 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10115 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10116 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10117 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10118 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10119 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10120 appropriate server.
10121
10122 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10123
10124 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10125 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10126
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010127 See also: "option transparent"
10128
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010129unique-id-format <string>
10130 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10132 yes | yes | yes | no
10133 Arguments :
10134 <string> is a log-format string.
10135
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010136 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10137 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10138 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10139 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010140
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010141 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10142 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10143 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10144 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10145 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10146 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10147 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10148 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010149
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010150 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10151 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010152
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010153 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010154
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010155 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010156
10157 will generate:
10158
10159 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10160
10161 See also: "unique-id-header"
10162
10163unique-id-header <name>
10164 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10166 yes | yes | yes | no
10167 Arguments :
10168 <name> is the name of the header.
10169
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010170 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10171 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010172
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010173 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010174
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010175 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010176 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10177
10178 will generate:
10179
10180 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10181
10182 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010183
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010184use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010185 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10187 no | yes | yes | no
10188 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010189 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10190 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010191
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010192 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10193 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010194
10195 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10196 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10197 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010198 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10199 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10200 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10201 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010202
10203 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10204 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10205 assign the backend.
10206
10207 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10208 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10209 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10210 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10211 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10212 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10213
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010214 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010215 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010216 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10217 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10218 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10219
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010220 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10221 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10222 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10223 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10224 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10225 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10226 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10227 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10228 cannot be forced from the request.
10229
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010230 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010231 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10232 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10233
10234 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10235 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010236
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010237
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010238use-server <server> if <condition>
10239use-server <server> unless <condition>
10240 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10242 no | no | yes | yes
10243 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010244 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010245
10246 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10247
10248 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10249 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10250 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10251
10252 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10253 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10254 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10255 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10256 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10257 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10258 matches will assign the server.
10259
10260 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10261 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10262 with the next rules until one matches.
10263
10264 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10265 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10266 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10267 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10268
10269 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10270 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10271 stripped.
10272
10273 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10274 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10275 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10276 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10277
10278 Example :
10279 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10280 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10281 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10282 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10283 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10284 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010285 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010286 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10287 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10288
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010289 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010290
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010291
102925. Bind and Server options
10293--------------------------
10294
10295The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10296depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10297settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10298written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10299described in this section.
10300
10301
103025.1. Bind options
10303-----------------
10304
10305The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10306as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10307no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10308parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10309while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10310provided immediately after the setting name.
10311
10312The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10313
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010314accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10315 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10316 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10317 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10318 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10319 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10320 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10321 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10322 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10323 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010324 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10325 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10326 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010327
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010328accept-proxy
10329 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010330 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10331 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010332 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10333 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10334 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10335 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10336 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10337 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10338 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010339 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10340 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010341
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010342allow-0rtt
10343 Allow receiving early data when using TLS 1.3. This is disabled by default,
10344 due to security considerations.
10345
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010346alpn <protocols>
10347 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10348 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10349 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10350 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10351 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10352 initial NPN extension.
10353
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010354backlog <backlog>
10355 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10356 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10357
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010358curves <curves>
10359 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10360 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10361 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10362 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10363 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10364 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10365
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010366ecdhe <named curve>
10367 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010368 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10369 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010370
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010371ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010372 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10373 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10374 client's certificate.
10375
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010376ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10378 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10379 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10380 error is ignored.
10381
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010382ca-sign-file <cafile>
10383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10384 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10385 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10386 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10387 'generate-certificates' for details.
10388
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010389ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010390 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10391 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10392 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10393 'generate-certificates' for details.
10394
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010395ciphers <ciphers>
10396 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10397 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010398 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010399 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10400 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
Daniel Schneller87e43022017-09-01 19:29:57 +020010401 Depending on the compatiblity and security requirements, the list of suitable
10402 ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background information and
10403 recommendations see e. g. (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS)
10404 and (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010405
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010406crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010407 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10408 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10409 to verify client's certificate.
10410
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010411crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010412 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10413 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10414 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10415 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10416 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10417 file.
10418
10419 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10420 are loaded.
10421
10422 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010423 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010424 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10425 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10426 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10427 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10428 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10429 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10430 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010431
10432 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10433 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10434 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10435 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010436 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10437 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010438
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010439 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010440
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010441 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10442 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010443 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010444 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10445 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10446 clients).
10447
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010448 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10449 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10450 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10451 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10452 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10453 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10454 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10455 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10456 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10457 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10458 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10459 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10460 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10461
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010462 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10463 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10464 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10465 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10466 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10467
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010468 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10469 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10470 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10471 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010472
10473 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10474 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10475 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10476 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10477 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10478 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10479 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10480 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10481 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10482
10483 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10484
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010485 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010486 a cert bundle.
10487
10488 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10489 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10490 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10491 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10492 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10493 provide multi-cert support.
10494
10495 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10496
10497 Filename | CN | SAN
10498 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10499 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010500 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010501 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10502 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10503
10504 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10505 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10506 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10507 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010508 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10509 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10510 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010511
10512 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10513 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10514
10515 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10516 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10517 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10518
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010519crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010520 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10521 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010522 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010523 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010524
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010525crt-list <file>
10526 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010527 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10528 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010529
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010530 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10531
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010532 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10533 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010534 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010535 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010536
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010537 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10538 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10539 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10540 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10541 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10542 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10543 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10544 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010545
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010546 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010547 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010548 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10549 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10550 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010551
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010552 crt-list file example:
10553 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010554 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010555 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010556 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010557
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010558defer-accept
10559 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10560 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10561 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10562 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10563 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10564 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10565 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10566 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10567 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10568 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10569 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10570
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010571expose-fd listeners
10572 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10573 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010574 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10575 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010576 See alors "-x" in the management guide.
10577
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010578force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010579 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010580 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010581 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010582 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010583
10584force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010585 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010586 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010587 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010588
10589force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010590 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010591 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010592 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010593
10594force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010595 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010596 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010597 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010598
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010599force-tlsv13
10600 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10601 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010602 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010603
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010604generate-certificates
10605 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10606 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10607 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10608 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10609 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10610 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10611 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10612 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10613 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10614 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10615 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10616
10617 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10618 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10619 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10620 certificate is used many times.
10621
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010622gid <gid>
10623 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10624 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10625 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10626 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10627 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10628
10629group <group>
10630 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10631 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10632 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10633 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10634 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10635
10636id <id>
10637 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10638 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10639 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10640 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10641
10642interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010643 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10644 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10645 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10646 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10647 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10648 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10649 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010650
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010651level <level>
10652 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10653 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10654 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10655 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10656 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10657 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10658 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10659 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10660 counters).
10661 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10662 all counters).
10663
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010664severity-output <format>
10665 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10666 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10667 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10668 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10669 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10670 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10671 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10672 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10673 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10674 rfc5424 convention.
10675
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010676maxconn <maxconn>
10677 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10678 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10679 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10680 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10681 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10682 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10683 eat all memory.
10684
10685mode <mode>
10686 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10687 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10688 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10689 UNIX sockets.
10690
10691mss <maxseg>
10692 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10693 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10694 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10695 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10696 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10697 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10698 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10699 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10700 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10701 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10702 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10703
10704name <name>
10705 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10706 page.
10707
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010708namespace <name>
10709 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10710 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10711 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10712 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10713
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010714nice <nice>
10715 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10716 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10717 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10718 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10719 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10720 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10721 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10722 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10723 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10724 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10725 one for an RDP socket.
10726
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010727no-ca-names
10728 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10729 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10730
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010731no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010732 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010733 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010734 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010735 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010736 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10737 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010738
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010739no-tls-tickets
10740 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10741 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10742 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010743 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10744 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010745
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010746no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010747 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010748 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010749 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010750 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010751 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10752 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010753
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010754no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010755 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010756 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010757 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010758 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010759 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10760 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010761
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010762no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010763 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010764 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010765 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010766 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010767 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10768 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010769
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010770no-tlsv13
10771 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10772 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10773 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10774 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010775 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10776 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010777
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010778npn <protocols>
10779 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10780 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10781 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10782 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010783 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10784 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010785
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010786prefer-client-ciphers
10787 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10788 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10789 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10790
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010791process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10792 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10793 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10794 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10795 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10796 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10797 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10798 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010799 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10800 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10801 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10802 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10803 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10804 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10805 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010806
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010807ssl
10808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010809 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010810 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10811 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020010812 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
10813 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010814
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010815ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10816 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10817 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10818 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10819
10820ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10821 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10822 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10823 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10824
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010825strict-sni
10826 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10827 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10828 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10829 See the "crt" option for more information.
10830
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010831tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010832 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010833 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10834 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010835 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010836 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10837 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10838 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10839 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10840 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10841 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10842 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10843
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010844tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010845 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010846 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10847 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10848 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10849 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10850 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10851 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10852 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010853 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10854 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10855 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010856
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010857tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10858 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10859 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10860 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10861 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10862 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10863 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10864 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10865 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10866 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10867 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10868
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010869transparent
10870 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10871 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10872 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10873 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10874 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10875 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10876 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10877 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10878 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10879 so check for support with your vendor.
10880
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010881v4v6
10882 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10883 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10884 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10885 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010886 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010887
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010888v6only
10889 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10890 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10891 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010892 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10893 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010894
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010895uid <uid>
10896 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10897 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10898 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10899 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10900 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10901
10902user <user>
10903 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10904 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10905 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10906 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10907 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10908
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010909verify [none|optional|required]
10910 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10911 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10912 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10913 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10914 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010915 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10916 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10917 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10918 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010919
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200109205.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010921------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010922
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010923The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10924which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10925arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10926settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10927after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10928Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10929address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010931 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010932 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010933
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010934Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10935keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10936
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010937The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010938
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010939addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010940 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010941 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10942 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10943 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10944 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10945 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010946
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010947agent-check
10948 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010949 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10950 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10951 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10952 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010953
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010954 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010955 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010956 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10957 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10958 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010959
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010960 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10961 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10962 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10963 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10964 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10965
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010966 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10967 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010968
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010969 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10970 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10971 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010972
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010973 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10974 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10975 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010976
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010977 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10978 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10979 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10980 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10981 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10982 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10983 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010984
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010985 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10986 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010987
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010988 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10989 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10990 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10991 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10992 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10993 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10994 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10995 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10996 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010997
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010998 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10999 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011000 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11001 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11002 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011003 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011004
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011005 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011006 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011007
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011008agent-send <string>
11009 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11010 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11011 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11012 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11013 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11014
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011015agent-inter <delay>
11016 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11017 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11018
11019 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11020 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11021 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11022 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11023 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11024 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11025 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11026 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11027 of backends use the same servers.
11028
11029 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11030
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011031agent-addr <addr>
11032 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11033
11034 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11035 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11036 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11037 hostname, it will be resolved.
11038
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011039agent-port <port>
11040 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11041
11042 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11043
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011044backup
11045 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11046 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11047 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11048 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011049 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11050 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011051
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011052ca-file <cafile>
11053 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11054 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11055 server's certificate.
11056
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011057check
11058 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011059 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11060 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11061 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11062 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11063 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11064 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11065 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011066 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11067 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011068 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11069 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011070
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011071check-send-proxy
11072 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11073 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11074 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11075 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11076 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11077 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11078 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11079
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011080check-sni
11081 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11082 over SSL.
11083
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011084check-ssl
11085 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11086 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11087 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11088 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011089 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011090 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11091 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
11092 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011093 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11094 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011095
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011096ciphers <ciphers>
11097 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011098 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011099 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11100 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11101 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11102 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11103 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11104 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011106cookie <value>
11107 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11108 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11109 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11110 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11111 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11112 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11113 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11114
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011115crl-file <crlfile>
11116 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11117 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11118 to verify server's certificate.
11119
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011120crt <cert>
11121 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11122 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11123 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11124 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11125 certificate request.
11126
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011127disabled
11128 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11129 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11130 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11131 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11132 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011133 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011134
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011135enabled
11136 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11137 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11138 default value.
11139 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11140 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011141
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011142error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011143 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11144 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11145 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011146
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011147 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011148
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011149fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011150 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11151 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11152 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11153
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011154force-sslv3
11155 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11156 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011157 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011158 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011159
11160force-tlsv10
11161 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011162 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011163 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011164
11165force-tlsv11
11166 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011167 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011168 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011169
11170force-tlsv12
11171 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011172 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011173 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011174
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011175force-tlsv13
11176 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11177 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011178 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011180id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011181 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11182 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11183 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011184
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011185init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11186 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11187 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
11188 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
11189 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11190 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11191 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11192 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11193 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11194 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11195 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11196 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11197 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
11198 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
11199 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11200 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11201 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11202 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11203 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11204 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
11205 historic behaviour.
11206
11207 Example:
11208 defaults
11209 # never fail on address resolution
11210 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11211
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011212inter <delay>
11213fastinter <delay>
11214downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011215 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11216 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11217 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11218 between checks depending on the server state :
11219
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011220 Server state | Interval used
11221 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11222 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11223 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11224 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11225 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11226 or yet unchecked. |
11227 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11228 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11229 | "inter" otherwise.
11230 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011232 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11233 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11234 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11235 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011236 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11237 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11238 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11239 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11240 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011242maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011243 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11244 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11245 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11246 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11247 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11248 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11249 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11250 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011252maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011253 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11254 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11255 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11256 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11257 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11258 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11259 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11260
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011261minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011262 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11263 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11264 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11265 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11266 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11267 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011268 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011269 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011270
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011271namespace <name>
11272 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11273 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11274 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11275 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11276
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011277no-agent-check
11278 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11279 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11280 default value.
11281 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11282 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11283
11284no-backup
11285 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11286 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11287 default value.
11288 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11289 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11290
11291no-check
11292 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11293 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11294 default value.
11295 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11296 "default-server" "check" setting.
11297
11298no-check-ssl
11299 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11300 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11301 default value.
11302 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11303 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11304
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011305no-send-proxy
11306 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11307 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11308 default value.
11309 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11310 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11311
11312no-send-proxy-v2
11313 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11314 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11315 default value.
11316 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11317 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11318
11319no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11320 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11321 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11322 default value.
11323 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11324 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11325
11326no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11327 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11328 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11329 default value.
11330 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11331 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11332
11333no-ssl
11334 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11335 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11336 default value.
11337 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11338 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11339
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011340no-ssl-reuse
11341 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11342 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11343 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11344 and for paranoid users.
11345
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011346no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011347 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11348 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011349 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011350
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011351 Supported in default-server: No
11352
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011353no-tls-tickets
11354 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11355 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11356 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011357 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11358 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011359 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011360
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011361no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011362 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011363 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11364 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011365 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11366 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011367 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011368
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011369 Supported in default-server: No
11370
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011371no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011372 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011373 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11374 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011375 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11376 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011377 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011378
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011379 Supported in default-server: No
11380
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011381no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011382 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011383 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11384 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011385 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11386 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011387 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011388
11389 Supported in default-server: No
11390
11391no-tlsv13
11392 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11393 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11394 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11395 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11396 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011397 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011398
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011399 Supported in default-server: No
11400
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011401no-verifyhost
11402 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11403 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11404 default value.
11405 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11406 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011407
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011408non-stick
11409 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11410 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11411 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011413observe <mode>
11414 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11415 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11416 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11417 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11418 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11419 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011420 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011421
11422 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11423
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011424on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011425 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11426 Currently, four modes are available:
11427 - fastinter: force fastinter
11428 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11429 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11430 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11431 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11432
11433 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11434
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011435on-marked-down <action>
11436 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11437 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011438 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11439 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11440 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11441 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11442 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11443 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11444 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11445 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011446
11447 Actions are disabled by default
11448
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011449on-marked-up <action>
11450 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11451 Currently one action is available:
11452 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11453 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11454 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11455 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11456 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11457 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11458 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11459 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11460
11461 Actions are disabled by default
11462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011463port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011464 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11465 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11466 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11467 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11468 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11469 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11470
11471redir <prefix>
11472 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11473 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11474 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11475 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11476 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11477 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11478 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11479 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011480 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011481 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11482 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11483 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11484 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11485 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11486
11487 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011489rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011490 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11491 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11492 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11493
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011494resolve-prefer <family>
11495 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11496 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11497 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11498 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11499
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011500 Default value: ipv6
11501
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011502 Example:
11503
11504 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011505
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011506resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11507 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11508 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011509 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011510 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11511 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11512 configured network, another address is selected.
11513
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011514 Example:
11515
11516 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011517
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011518resolvers <id>
11519 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11520 hostname.
11521
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011522 Example:
11523
11524 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011525
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011526 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011527
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011528send-proxy
11529 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11530 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11531 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11532 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011533 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11534 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11535 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11536 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11537 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11538 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11539 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11540 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11541 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11542 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011543 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11544 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011545
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011546send-proxy-v2
11547 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11548 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11549 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11550 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011551 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11552 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11553 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11554 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011555
11556send-proxy-v2-ssl
11557 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11558 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11559 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11560 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11561 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11562 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11563 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011564 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11565 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011566
11567send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11568 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11569 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11570 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11571 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11572 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11573 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11574 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11575 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011576 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11577 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011579slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011580 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11581 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11582 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11583 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11584 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11585 parameters :
11586
11587 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11588 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11589
11590 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11591 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11592 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11593 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11594
11595 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11596 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11597 seen as failed.
11598
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011599sni <expression>
11600 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11601 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11602 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11603 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011604 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11605 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011606 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11607 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011608
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011609source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011610source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011611source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011612 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11613 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11614 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11615 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11616
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011617 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11618 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11619 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11620 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11621 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11622 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11623 server.
11624
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011625 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11626 specifying the source address without port(s).
11627
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011628ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011629 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11630 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11631 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11632 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11633 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11634 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011635 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11636 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011637
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011638ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11639 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11640 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11641 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11642
11643ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11644 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11645 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11646 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11647
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011648ssl-reuse
11649 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11650 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11651 default value.
11652 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11653 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11654
11655stick
11656 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11657 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11658 default value.
11659 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11660 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011661
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011662tcp-ut <delay>
11663 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11664 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11665 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011666 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011667 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11668 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11669 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11670 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11671 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11672 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11673 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11674 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11675 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011677track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011678 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11679 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11680 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11681 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011682 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11683
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011684tls-tickets
11685 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11686 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11687 default value.
11688 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11689 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011690
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011691verify [none|required]
11692 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011693 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011694 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
11695 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
11696 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributs match either
11697 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
11698 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
11699 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
11700 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
11701 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
11702 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
11703 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
11704 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011705
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011706verifyhost <hostname>
11707 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011708 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
11709 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
11710 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
11711 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
11712 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
11713 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
11714 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
11715 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011717weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011718 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11719 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11720 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011721 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11722 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11723 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11724 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11725 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11726 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011727
11728
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117295.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11730-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011731
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011732HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11733using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11734configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011735This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11736can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11737workload.
11738This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11739resolution at run time.
11740Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11741carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11742
11743
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117445.3.1. Global overview
11745----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011746
11747As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11748different steps of the process life:
11749
11750 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11751 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11752 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11753
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011754 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
11755 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011756
11757A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11758 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11759 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11760 resolution to know this new IP.
11761
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011762When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
11763HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
11764SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
11765from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
11766will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
11767will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020011768
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011769A few things important to notice:
11770 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11771 first valid response.
11772
11773 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11774 servers return an error.
11775
11776
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117775.3.2. The resolvers section
11778----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011779
11780This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011781HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
11782contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011783
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011784When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11785uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11786is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11787answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11788
11789When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011790used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011791
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011792 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
11793 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
11794 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011795
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011796 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
11797 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011798
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011799 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
11800 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
11801 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011802
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011803For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
11804following scenarios are possible:
11805
11806 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
11807 ignored
11808
11809 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11810 applied
11811
11812 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11813 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
11814
11815 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
11816 retries the query with a new type
11817
11818 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
11819 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011820
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011821As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
11822a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011823<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011824
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011825
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011826resolvers <resolvers id>
11827 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11828
11829A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11830
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011831accepted_payload_size <nb>
11832 Defines the maxium payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011833 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011834 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
11835 by RFC 6891)
11836
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011837 Note: to get bigger responses but still be sure that responses won't be
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011838 dropped on the wire, one can choose a value between 1280 and 1410.
11839
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011840 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
11841
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011842nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11843 DNS server description:
11844 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11845 <ip> : IP address of the server
11846 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11847
11848hold <status> <period>
11849 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11850 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011851 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011852 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011853 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11854 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11855 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11856
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020011857 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011858
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011859resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020011860 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
11861 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
11862 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
11863
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011864resolve_retries <nb>
11865 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11866 giving up.
11867 Default value: 3
11868
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011869 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11870 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11871 type.
11872
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011873timeout <event> <time>
11874 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11875 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11876 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011877 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
11878 other time applied.
11879 Default value: 1s
11880 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
11881 have been received.
11882 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011883 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11884 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11885
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011886 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011887
11888 resolvers mydns
11889 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11890 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11891 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011892 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011893 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011894 hold other 30s
11895 hold refused 30s
11896 hold nx 30s
11897 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011898 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011899 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011900
11901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119026. HTTP header manipulation
11903---------------------------
11904
11905In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11906response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11907request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11908which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011909against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011910
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011911If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11912to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11913but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11914HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11915stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11916because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11917a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11918still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011920This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11921in section 4.2 :
11922
11923 - reqadd <string>
11924 - reqallow <search>
11925 - reqiallow <search>
11926 - reqdel <search>
11927 - reqidel <search>
11928 - reqdeny <search>
11929 - reqideny <search>
11930 - reqpass <search>
11931 - reqipass <search>
11932 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11933 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11934 - reqtarpit <search>
11935 - reqitarpit <search>
11936 - rspadd <string>
11937 - rspdel <search>
11938 - rspidel <search>
11939 - rspdeny <search>
11940 - rspideny <search>
11941 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11942 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11943
11944With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11945is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11946parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11947prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11948Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11949
11950 \t for a tab
11951 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11952 \n for a new line (LF)
11953 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11954 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11955 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11956 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11957 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11958
11959The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11960portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11961above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11962regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
119639 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11964is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11965
11966The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11967after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11968
11969Notes related to these keywords :
11970---------------------------------
11971 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11972 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11973 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11974
11975 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11976 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11977 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11978
11979 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11980 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11981 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11982 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11983 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11984
11985 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11986 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11987 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11988 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11989 useless headers before adding new ones.
11990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011991 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011992 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11993
11994 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11995 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11996 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11997
11998 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11999 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012000 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012001
12002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120037. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12004----------------------------------
12005
12006Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
12007client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12008The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12009these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12010but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12011data called patterns.
12012
12013
120147.1. ACL basics
12015---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012016
12017The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12018content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12019from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12020simple :
12021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012022 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012023 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012024 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12025 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012027The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12028adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012029
12030In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012032 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012033
12034This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12035Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12036and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012037an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12038conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12039as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12040are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012041
12042ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12043'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12044which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12045
12046There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12047performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012049The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12050specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12051this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012052methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12053ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012054
12055Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12056 - boolean
12057 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12058 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12059 - string
12060 - data block
12061
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012062Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12063converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12064would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12065The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12066which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12067
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012068Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12069keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12070fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12071which are summarized in the table below :
12072
12073 +---------------------+-----------------+
12074 | Sample or converter | Default |
12075 | output type | matching method |
12076 +---------------------+-----------------+
12077 | boolean | bool |
12078 +---------------------+-----------------+
12079 | integer | int |
12080 +---------------------+-----------------+
12081 | ip | ip |
12082 +---------------------+-----------------+
12083 | string | str |
12084 +---------------------+-----------------+
12085 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12086 +---------------------+-----------------+
12087
12088Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12089matching method, see below.
12090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012091The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12092 - boolean
12093 - integer or integer range
12094 - IP address / network
12095 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12096 - regular expression
12097 - hex block
12098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012099The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12100
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012101 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12102 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012103 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012104 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012105 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012106 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012107 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012109The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12110read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12111if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12112lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12113will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12114beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12115a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12116lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12117exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12118
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012119The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12120parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12121ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12122a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12123check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12124
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012125The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12126socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12127file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012129Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12130loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12131
12132 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12133
12134In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12135the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12136case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12137as well.
12138
12139The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12140sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12141do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12142methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12143is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
12144obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
12145followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12146default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12147that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12148string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12149
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012150The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12151By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12152string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12153resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12154server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12155waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12156flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12157function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012159There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12160sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12161be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012162
12163 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12164 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012165 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12166 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12167 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12168 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012169
12170 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12171 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012172 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012173
12174 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012175 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012176
12177 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012178 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012179
12180 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
12181 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12182
12183 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12184 binary or string samples.
12185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012186 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12187 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012189 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12190 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12191 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012193 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12194 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012196 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12197 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012199 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12200 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012202 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12203 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012204 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012206 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12207 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12208 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012209
12210For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12211request, it is possible to do :
12212
12213 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12214
12215In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12216buffer, one would use the following acl :
12217
12218 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12219
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012220On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12221possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12222
12223 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012225All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12226criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12227method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12228to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12229criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12230the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012232If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012233the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12234For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012236 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12237 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12238 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12239 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012240
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012241
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012242The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12243types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12244combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12245brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12246default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012248 +-------------------------------------------------+
12249 | Input sample type |
12250 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012251 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012252 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12253 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12254 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012255 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012256 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012257 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012258 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012259 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012260 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012261 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012262 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012263 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012264 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012265 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012266 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012267 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012268 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012269 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012270 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012271 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012272 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012273 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012274 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012275 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012276 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12277 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12278 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012279
12280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122817.1.1. Matching booleans
12282------------------------
12283
12284In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12285Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12286When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12287that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12288
12289Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12290return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12291"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12292
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122947.1.2. Matching integers
12295------------------------
12296
12297Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12298enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12299to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12300
12301Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12302matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12303lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012304
12305For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12306unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12307representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12308
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012309As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12310two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12311instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12312ranges and operators.
12313
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012314For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012315operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12316Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12317of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012318
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012319Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012320
12321 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12322 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12323 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12324 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12325 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12326
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012327For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012328
12329 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12330
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012331This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12332
12333 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12334
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123367.1.3. Matching strings
12337-----------------------
12338
12339String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12340different forms :
12341
12342 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12343 patterns ;
12344
12345 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12346 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12347
12348 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12349 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12350
12351 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12352 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12353
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012354 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012355 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12356 matches.
12357
12358 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12359 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12360 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012361
12362String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12363exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12364characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12365string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12366to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012367before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012368
12369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123707.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12371---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012372
12373Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12374they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12375possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12376passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12377the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012378the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12379match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012380
12381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12383-------------------------------------
12384
12385It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12386not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12387a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12388to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12389digits may be used upper or lower case.
12390
12391Example :
12392 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12393 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12394
12395
123967.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12397---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012398
12399IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12400netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12401within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012402host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012403difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12404at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12405does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12406parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012407
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012408The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12409abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12410
12411 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12412 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12413 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12414 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12415 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12416 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12417 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12418 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12419
12420Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12421192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12422
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012423IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12424Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12425trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12426IPv6 patterns.
12427
12428HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12429following situations :
12430 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12431 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12432 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12433 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12434 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12435 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12436 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12437 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12438 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12439 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012441
124427.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12443----------------------------------
12444
12445Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12446combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12447
12448 - AND (implicit)
12449 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12450 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012452A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012454 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012456Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12457indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012459For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12460"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12461requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12462is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12463
12464 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012465 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12466 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12467 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012468
12469To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12470and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12471
12472 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12473 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12474 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12475 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12476
12477 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12478 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12479 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12480 use_backend www if host_www
12481
12482It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12483expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12484be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12485the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12486
12487 The following rule :
12488
12489 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012490 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012491
12492 Can also be written that way :
12493
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012494 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012495
12496It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12497to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12498simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12499sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12500good use is the following :
12501
12502 With named ACLs :
12503
12504 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12505 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12506 monitor fail if site_dead
12507
12508 With anonymous ACLs :
12509
12510 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12511
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012512See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12513keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012514
12515
125167.3. Fetching samples
12517---------------------
12518
12519Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12520against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12521sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12522ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12523of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12524available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12525
12526This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12527Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12528compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12529deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12530
12531The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12532matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12533method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12534indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12535
12536As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12537when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12538mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12539the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12540ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12541
12542Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12543multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12544when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12545incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12546are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12547is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12548all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12549
12550Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12551 - name
12552 - name(arg1)
12553 - name(arg1,arg2)
12554
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012555
125567.3.1. Converters
12557-----------------
12558
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012559Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12560of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12561is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12562was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12563has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12564unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12565
12566These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12567sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12568the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12569support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012570
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012571A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12572support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12573supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12574(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12575bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012577The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012578
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001257951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12580 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12581 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12582 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12583 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12584 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12585
12586 Example :
12587 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12588 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12589 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12590 frontend http-in
12591 bind *:8081
12592 default_backend servers
12593 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12594 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12595
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012596add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012597 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012598 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012599 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12600 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012601 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012602 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12603 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12604 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12605 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12606 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012607 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012608
12609and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012610 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012611 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012612 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12613 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012614 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012615 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12616 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12617 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12618 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12619 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012620 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012621
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012622b64dec
12623 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12624 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12625
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012626base64
12627 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12628 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12629 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12630
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012631bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012632 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012633 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12634 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12635 presence of a flag).
12636
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012637bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12638 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12639 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012640 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012641
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012642cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012643 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12644 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012645
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012646crc32([<avalanche>])
12647 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12648 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12649 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12650 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12651 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12652 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12653 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12654 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12655 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12656 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12657 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12658
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012659da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012660 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12661 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12662 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12663 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012664 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012665 configuration language.
12666
12667 Example:
12668 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012669 bind *:8881
12670 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012671 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012672
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012673debug
12674 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12675 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12676 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12677
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012678div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012679 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12680 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012681 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012682 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12683 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012684 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012685 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12686 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12687 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12688 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12689 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012690 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012691
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012692djb2([<avalanche>])
12693 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12694 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12695 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12696 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12697 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12698 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12699 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012700 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12701 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012702
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012703even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012704 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012705 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12706
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012707field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12708 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12709 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12710 list of chars.
12711
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012712hex
12713 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12714 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12715 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12716 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012717
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020012718hex2i
12719 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
12720 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
12721
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012722http_date([<offset>])
12723 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12724 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12725 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12726 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12727 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12728 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012729
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012730in_table(<table>)
12731 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12732 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12733 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12734 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12735 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12736
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012737ipmask(<mask>)
12738 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12739 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12740 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12741 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12742
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012743json([<input-code>])
12744 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12745 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012746 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012747 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12748 of errors:
12749 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12750 bytes, ...)
12751 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12752 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12753
12754 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12755 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12756 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12757 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12758 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12759 are :
12760 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12761 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12762 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12763 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12764 error ;
12765 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12766 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12767
12768 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12769 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12770
12771 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012772 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012773 capture request header user-agent len 150
12774 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012775
12776 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12777 GET / HTTP/1.0
12778 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12779
12780 Output log:
12781 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12782
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012783language(<value>[,<default>])
12784 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12785 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12786 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12787 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12788 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12789 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12790 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12791 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12792 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12793 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12794 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12795 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012796
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012797 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012798
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012799 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12800 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012801
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012802 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12803 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12804 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12805 use_backend spanish if es
12806 use_backend french if fr
12807 use_backend english if en
12808 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012809
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012810lower
12811 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12812 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12813 type. The result is of type string.
12814
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012815ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12816 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12817 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12818 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12819 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12820 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12821 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12822
12823 Example :
12824
12825 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12826 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12827 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12828
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012829map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12830map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12831map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12832 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12833 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12834 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12835 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12836 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12837 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12838 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12839 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012840
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012841 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12842 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12843 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012844
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012845 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012846 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012847
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012848 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12849 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12850 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12851 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012852 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12853 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012854 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12855 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12856 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12857 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12858 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12859 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12860 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12861 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012862 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12863 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12864 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012865 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12866 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12867 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12868 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12869 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012870
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012871 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12872 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12873 the corresponding match text.
12874
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012875 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12876 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12877 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12878 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12879 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012880
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012881 Example :
12882
12883 # this is a comment and is ignored
12884 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12885 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12886 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12887 | | | `---------- value
12888 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12889 | `---------------------------- key
12890 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12891
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012892mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012893 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12894 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012895 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012896 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012897 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012898 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12899 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12900 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12901 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12902 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012903 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012904
12905mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012906 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012907 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12908 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012909 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012910 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012911 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012912 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12913 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12914 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12915 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12916 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012917 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012918
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012919nbsrv
12920 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12921 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12922 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12923 map lookup.
12924
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012925neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012926 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12927 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12928 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12929 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012930
12931not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012932 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012933 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12934 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12935 absence of a flag).
12936
12937odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012938 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012939 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12940
12941or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012942 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012943 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012944 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12945 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012946 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012947 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12948 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12949 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12950 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12951 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012952 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012953
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012954regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012955 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12956 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12957 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12958 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12959 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12960 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12961 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12962 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12963 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12964 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012965 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12966 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12967 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12968 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012969
12970 Example :
12971
12972 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12973 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12974 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12975 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12976
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012977capture-req(<id>)
12978 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12979 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12980
12981 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012982 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12983 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012984
12985capture-res(<id>)
12986 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12987 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12988
12989 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012990 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12991 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012992
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012993sdbm([<avalanche>])
12994 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12995 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12996 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12997 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12998 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12999 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13000 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013001 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
13002 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013003
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013004set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013005 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
13006 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
13007 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013008 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013009 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13010 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013011 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013012 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13013 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013014 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013015 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013016
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013017sha1
13018 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13019 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13020
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013021sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013022 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13023 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013024 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013025 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13026 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013027 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013028 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13029 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013030 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013031 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13032 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013033 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013034 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013035
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013036table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13037 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13038 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13039 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13040 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13041 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13042 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13043
13044
13045table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13046 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13047 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13048 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13049 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13050 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13051 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13052
13053table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13054 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13055 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13056 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13057 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13058 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13059
13060table_conn_cur(<table>)
13061 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13062 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13063 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13064 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13065 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13066
13067table_conn_rate(<table>)
13068 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13069 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13070 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13071 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13072 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13073
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013074table_gpt0(<table>)
13075 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13076 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13077 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13078 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13079 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13080
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013081table_gpc0(<table>)
13082 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13083 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13084 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13085 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13086 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13087
13088table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13089 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13090 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13091 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13092 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13093 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13094 sample fetch keyword.
13095
13096table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13097 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13098 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13099 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13100 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13101 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13102
13103table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13104 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13105 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13106 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13107 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13108 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13109 keyword.
13110
13111table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13112 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13113 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13114 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13115 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13116 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13117
13118table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13119 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13120 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13121 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13122 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13123 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13124 keyword.
13125
13126table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13127 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13128 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13129 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
13130 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13131 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13132 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13133 keyword.
13134
13135table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13136 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13137 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13138 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
13139 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13140 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13141 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13142 keyword.
13143
13144table_server_id(<table>)
13145 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13146 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13147 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13148 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13149 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13150 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13151
13152table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13153 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13154 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13155 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13156 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13157 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13158 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13159 keyword.
13160
13161table_sess_rate(<table>)
13162 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13163 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13164 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13165 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13166 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13167 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13168 keyword.
13169
13170table_trackers(<table>)
13171 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13172 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13173 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13174 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13175 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13176 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13177 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13178 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13179 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13180 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13181
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013182upper
13183 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13184 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13185 type. The result is of type string.
13186
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013187url_dec
13188 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13189 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13190
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013191unset-var(<var name>)
13192 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13193 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13194 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13195 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13196 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13197 response),
13198 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13199 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13200 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13201 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13202
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013203utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13204 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13205 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13206 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13207 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13208 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13209 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13210
13211 Example :
13212
13213 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
13214 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
13215 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13216
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013217word(<index>,<delimiters>)
13218 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
13219 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13220
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013221wt6([<avalanche>])
13222 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13223 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13224 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13225 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13226 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13227 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13228 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013229 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13230 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013231
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013232xor(<value>)
13233 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013234 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013235 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013236 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013237 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013238 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13239 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013240 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013241 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13242 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013243 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013244 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013245
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013246xxh32([<seed>])
13247 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13248 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13249 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13250 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13251 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13252 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13253 as cryptographically secure.
13254
13255xxh64([<seed>])
13256 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13257 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13258 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13259 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13260 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13261 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13262 as cryptographically secure.
13263
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013264
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132657.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013266--------------------------------------------
13267
13268A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13269not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13270"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13271The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13272
13273always_false : boolean
13274 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13275 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13276
13277always_true : boolean
13278 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13279 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13280
13281avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013282 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013283 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13284 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13285 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13286 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13287 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13288 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13289 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13290 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13291 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13292 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13293 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13294 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13295 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013297be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013298 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13299 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13300 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13301 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13302 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013304be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13305 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13306 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13307 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13308 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13309 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13310 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013311
13312 Example :
13313 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13314 backend dynamic
13315 mode http
13316 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13317 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013318
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013319bin(<hexa>) : bin
13320 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13321 of the string.
13322
13323bool(<bool>) : bool
13324 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13325 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013327connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13328 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013329 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013330 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13331 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013332
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013333 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013334 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013335 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13336
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013337 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13338 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013339
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013340 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013341 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013342 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013343 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13344 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013345 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013346 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013347
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013348 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13349 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013350 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013351 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013352
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013353date([<offset>]) : integer
13354 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13355 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13356 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13357 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013358 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13359
13360 Example :
13361
13362 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13363 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013364
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013365distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13366 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13367 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13368 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13369 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13370 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13371 list of supported tokens.
13372
13373distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13374 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13375 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13376 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13377 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13378 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13379 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13380 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13381 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13382 supported tokens.
13383
13384 Example :
13385 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13386 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13387 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13388 # send large files to the big farm
13389 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13390
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013391env(<name>) : string
13392 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13393 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13394 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13395 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13396 certain way.
13397
13398 Examples :
13399 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13400 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13401
13402 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13403 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013405fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13406 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013407 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13408 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013409 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13410 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13411 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13412 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13413 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013414
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013415fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13416 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13417 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13418 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013420fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13421 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13422 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13423 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13424 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13425 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13426 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13427 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13428 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013429
13430 Example :
13431 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13432 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13433 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13434 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13435 frontend mail
13436 bind :25
13437 mode tcp
13438 maxconn 100
13439 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13440 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13441 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13442 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013443
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013444hostname : string
13445 Returns the system hostname.
13446
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013447int(<integer>) : signed integer
13448 Returns a signed integer.
13449
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013450ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13451 Returns an ipv4.
13452
13453ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13454 Returns an ipv6.
13455
13456meth(<method>) : method
13457 Returns a method.
13458
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013459nbproc : integer
13460 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13461 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13462 and debugging purposes.
13463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013464nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13465 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13466 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13467 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013468 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13469 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13470 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013471
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013472proc : integer
13473 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13474 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13475 debugging purposes.
13476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013477queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013478 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13479 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13480 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013481 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13482 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13483 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13484 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13485 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13486
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013487rand([<range>]) : integer
13488 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13489 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13490 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13491 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13492 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013494srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13495 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13496 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13497 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13498 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13499 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13500 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13501 methods.
13502
13503srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13504 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13505 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13506 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13507 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13508 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13509 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13510 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13511
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013512srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13513 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13514 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13515 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13516 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13517 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13518 fetch methods.
13519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013520srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13521 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13522 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013523 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013524 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13525 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13526 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13527 overloading servers).
13528
13529 Example :
13530 # Redirect to a separate back
13531 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13532 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13533 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13534
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013535stopping : boolean
13536 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13537 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13538 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13539
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013540str(<string>) : string
13541 Returns a string.
13542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013543table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13544 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13545 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13546
13547table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13548 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13549 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13550 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13551
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013552var(<var-name>) : undefined
13553 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013554 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13555 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013556 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013557 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13558 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013559 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013560 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13561 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013562 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013563 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013564
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200135657.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013566----------------------------------
13567
13568The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13569closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13570methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13571sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13572TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013573the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13574counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13575"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013576argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13577the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13578this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013579
13580be_id : integer
13581 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13582 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13583
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013584be_name : string
13585 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13586 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013588dst : ip
13589 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13590 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13591 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13592 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13593 RFC 4291.
13594
13595dst_conn : integer
13596 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13597 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13598 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13599 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13600 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13601 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13602 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13603 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013604
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013605dst_is_local : boolean
13606 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13607 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13608 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13609 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13610 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13611 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13612 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13613 it only once per connection.
13614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013615dst_port : integer
13616 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13617 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13618 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13619 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13620 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13621 an HTTP header.
13622
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020013623fc_http_major : integer
13624 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
13625 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
13626 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
13627
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013628fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13629 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13630 header.
13631
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013632fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13633 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13634 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13635 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13636 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13637 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13638 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13639
13640fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13641 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13642 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13643 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13644 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13645 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13646 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13647
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013648fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13649 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13650 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13651 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13652 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13653
13654fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13655 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13656 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13657 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13658 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13659
13660fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13661 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13662 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13663 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13664 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13665
13666fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13667 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13668 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13669 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13670 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13671
13672fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13673 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13674 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13675 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13676 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13677
13678fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13679 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13680 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13681 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13682 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013684fe_id : integer
13685 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013686 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013687 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13688
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013689fe_name : string
13690 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13691 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13692 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13693
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013694sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013695sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13696sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13697sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013698 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13699 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13700 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13701
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013702sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013703sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13704sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13705sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013706 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13707 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13708 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13709
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013710sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013711sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13712sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13713sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013714 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13715 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013716 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13717 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13718 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013719
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013720 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013721 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13722 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013723 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13724 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13725 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013726 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13727 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13728
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013729sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013730sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13731sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13732sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013733 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13734 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13735
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013736sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013737sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13738sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13739sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013740 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13741 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13742 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13743
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013744sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013745sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13746sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13747sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013748 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13749 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13750 See also src_conn_rate.
13751
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013752sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013753sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13754sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13755sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013756 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013757 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013758
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013759sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13760sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13761sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13762sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13763 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13764 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13765
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013766sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013767sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13768sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13769sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013770 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13771 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13772 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013773 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13774 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13775 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013776
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013777sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013778sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13779sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13780sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013781 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13782 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13783 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13784
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013785sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013786sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13787sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13788sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013789 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13790 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13791 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13792 src_http_err_rate.
13793
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013794sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013795sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13796sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13797sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013798 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13799 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13800 src_http_req_cnt.
13801
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013802sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013803sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13804sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13805sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013806 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13807 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13808 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13809 src_http_req_rate.
13810
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013811sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013812sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13813sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13814sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013815 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013816 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13817 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13818 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13819 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013820
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013821 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013822 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13823 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013824 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13825
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013826sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013827sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13828sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13829sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013830 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13831 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13832 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013833
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013834sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013835sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13836sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13837sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013838 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13839 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13840 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013841
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013842sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013843sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13844sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13845sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013846 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13847 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13848 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13849 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013850 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013851 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13852
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013853sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013854sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13855sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13856sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013857 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13858 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13859 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13860 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13861 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013862 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013863
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013864sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013865sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13866sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13867sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013868 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13869 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13870 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13871
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013872sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013873sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13874sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13875sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013876 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13877 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013878 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013879 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13880 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013881 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13882 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13883 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013885so_id : integer
13886 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13887 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13888 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013890src : ip
13891 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13892 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13893 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13894 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013895 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13896 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13897 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13898 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013899
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013900 Example:
13901 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13902 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013904src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13905 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13906 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13907 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013908 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013910src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13911 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13912 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013913 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013914 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013916src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13917 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13918 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13919 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13920 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13921 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13922 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013923
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013924 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013925 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13926 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13927 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13928 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013929 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013930 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13931 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013933src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013934 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013935 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013936 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013937 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013939src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013940 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013941 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13942 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013943 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013945src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13946 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13947 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13948 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013949 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013951src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013952 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013953 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013954 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013955 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013956
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013957src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13958 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13959 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13960 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13961 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013963src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013964 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013965 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013966 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13967 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013968 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13969 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13970 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013972src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13973 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13974 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013975 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013976 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013977 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013979src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13980 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13981 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13982 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13983 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013984 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013986src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13987 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13988 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13989 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013990 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013992src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13993 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13994 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13995 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013996 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013997 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013999src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14000 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14001 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14002 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014003 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014004 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14005 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014006
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014007 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014008 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014009 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014010 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014011
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014012src_is_local : boolean
14013 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14014 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14015 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14016 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
14017 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
14018 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14019 once per connection.
14020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014021src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014022 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14023 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14024 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14025 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14026 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014028src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014029 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14030 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14031 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14032 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14033 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014035src_port : integer
14036 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14037 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14038 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14039 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014041src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14042 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014043 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14044 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14045 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014046 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014048src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14049 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14050 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14051 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14052 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014053 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014055src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14056 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14057 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14058 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14059 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14060 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14061 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14062 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14063 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014064
14065 Example :
14066 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14067 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14068 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14069 listen ssh
14070 bind :22
14071 mode tcp
14072 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014073 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014074 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014075 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014077srv_id : integer
14078 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14079 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14080 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014081
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014083----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014085The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14086closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14087when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14088usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014089future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014090
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001409151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14092 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14093 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14094 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14095 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14096 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14097
14098 Example :
14099 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14100 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14101 # the request.
14102 frontend http-in
14103 bind *:8081
14104 default_backend servers
14105 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14106 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14107
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014108ssl_bc : boolean
14109 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14110 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14111 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14112
14113ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14114 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14115 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14116
14117ssl_bc_cipher : string
14118 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14119 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14120
14121ssl_bc_protocol : string
14122 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14123 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14124
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014125ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014126 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014127 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14128 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014129
14130ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14131 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14132 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14133 if session was reused or not.
14134
14135ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14136 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14137 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014139ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14140 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14141 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14142 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14143 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14144 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014146ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14147 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14148 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14149 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14150 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014151
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014152ssl_c_der : binary
14153 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14154 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14155 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014157ssl_c_err : integer
14158 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14159 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14160 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14161 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14162 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014164ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14165 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14166 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14167 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14168 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14169 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14170 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14171 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14172 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014174ssl_c_key_alg : string
14175 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14176 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14177 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014179ssl_c_notafter : string
14180 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14181 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14182 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014184ssl_c_notbefore : string
14185 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14186 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14187 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014189ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14190 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14191 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14192 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14193 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14194 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14195 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14196 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14197 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014199ssl_c_serial : binary
14200 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14201 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14202 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014204ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14205 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14206 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14207 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014208 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14209 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14210
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014211 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014212 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014214ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14215 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14216 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14217 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014219ssl_c_used : boolean
14220 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14221 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014223ssl_c_verify : integer
14224 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14225 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14226 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14227 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014229ssl_c_version : integer
14230 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14231 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014232
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014233ssl_f_der : binary
14234 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14235 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14236 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014238ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14239 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14240 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14241 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14242 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014243 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014244 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14245 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14246 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014248ssl_f_key_alg : string
14249 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14250 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14251 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014253ssl_f_notafter : string
14254 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14255 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14256 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014258ssl_f_notbefore : string
14259 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14260 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14261 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014263ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14264 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14265 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14266 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14267 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14268 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14269 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14270 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14271 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014273ssl_f_serial : binary
14274 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14275 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14276 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014277
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014278ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14279 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14280 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14281 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014283ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14284 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14285 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14286 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014288ssl_f_version : integer
14289 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14290 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14291
14292ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014293 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14294 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14295 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014297 Example :
14298 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14299 listen http-https
14300 bind :80
14301 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14302 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14303
14304ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14305 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14306 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14307
14308ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014309 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014310 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14311 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14312 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14313 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14314 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14315 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14316 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14317 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014319ssl_fc_cipher : string
14320 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14321 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014322
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014323ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14324 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14325 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014326 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014327
14328ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14329 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14330 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014331 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014332
14333ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14334 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14335 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14336 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014337 avaible with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
14338 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014339
14340ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14341 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14342 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014343 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014345ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014346 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14347 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014348 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14349 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14350 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14351 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014352
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014353ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14354 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14355 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14356 wait until the handshake happened.
14357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014358ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14359 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014360 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14361 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14362 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14363 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014364
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014365ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014366 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14367 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014369ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014370 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014371 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14372 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14373 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14374 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14375 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14376 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14377 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014379ssl_fc_protocol : string
14380 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14381 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014382
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014383ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014384 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014385 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14386 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014388ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14389 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14390 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14391 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14392 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014394ssl_fc_sni : string
14395 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14396 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14397 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14398 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14399 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14400
14401 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14402 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14403 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014404 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14405 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014407 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014408 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14409 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014411ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14412 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14413 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014414
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014415
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144167.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014417------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014419Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14420sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14421only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14422For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14423be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14424can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14425sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14426for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14427content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014429payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14430 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14431 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14432 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014434payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14435 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14436 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14437 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014438
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014439req.hdrs : string
14440 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14441 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14442 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14443 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14444
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014445req.hdrs_bin : binary
14446 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14447 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14448 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14449 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14450 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14451 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14452
14453 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14454
14455 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14456 str: <int:length><bytes>
14457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014458req.len : integer
14459req_len : integer (deprecated)
14460 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14461 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14462 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14463 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14464 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14465 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14466 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14467 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014469req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14470 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014471 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14472 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14473 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14474 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014476 ACL alternatives :
14477 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014479req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14480 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14481 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14482 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14483 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014485 ACL alternatives :
14486 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014490req.proto_http : boolean
14491req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14492 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14493 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14494 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14495 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14496 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14497 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14498 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014500 Example:
14501 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14502 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14503 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014504 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014506req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14507rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14508 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14509 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14510 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14511 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14512 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14513 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14514 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014516 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14517 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14518 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14519 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14520 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14521 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014523 ACL derivatives :
14524 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014526 Example :
14527 listen tse-farm
14528 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14529 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14530 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14531 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14532 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14533 persist rdp-cookie
14534 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14535 # This is only useful makes sense if
14536 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14537 stick-table type string size 204800
14538 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14539 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14540 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014542 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14543 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014545req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14546rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14547 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14548 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14549 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14550 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014552 ACL derivatives :
14553 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014554
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014555req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14556 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14557 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014558 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14559 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14560 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14561 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14562 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014564req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14565req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14566 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14567 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14568 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14569 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14570 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14571 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14572 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014574req.ssl_sni : string
14575req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14576 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14577 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14578 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14579 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14580 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14581 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14582 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14583 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14584 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14585 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14586 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14587 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014589 ACL derivatives :
14590 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014592 Examples :
14593 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14594 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14595 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14596 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14597 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014598
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014599req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14600 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14601 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14602 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14603 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14604 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14605 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14606 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14607 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14608 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014610req.ssl_ver : integer
14611req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14612 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14613 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14614 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14615 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14616 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14617 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14618 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14619 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14620 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014622 ACL derivatives :
14623 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014624
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014625res.len : integer
14626 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14627 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14628 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14629 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14630 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14631 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14632 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14633 content inspection.
14634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014635res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14636 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014637 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14638 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14639 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14640 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014642res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14643 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14644 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14645 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14646 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014648 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014649
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014650res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14651rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14652 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14653 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14654 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14655 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14656 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14657 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14658 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014660wait_end : boolean
14661 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14662 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14663 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14664 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14665 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14666 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14667 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14668 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014670 Examples :
14671 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14672 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14673 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014675 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14676 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14677 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14678 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14679 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14680 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14681 tcp-request content reject
14682
14683
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014685--------------------------------------
14686
14687It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14688This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14689data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14690its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14691HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14692content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14693to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14694more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14695response are indexed.
14696
14697base : string
14698 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14699 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14700 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14701 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14702 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14703 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14704 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14705 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14706
14707 ACL derivatives :
14708 base : exact string match
14709 base_beg : prefix match
14710 base_dir : subdir match
14711 base_dom : domain match
14712 base_end : suffix match
14713 base_len : length match
14714 base_reg : regex match
14715 base_sub : substring match
14716
14717base32 : integer
14718 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14719 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14720 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014721 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14722 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14723 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014724
14725base32+src : binary
14726 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14727 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14728 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14729 per-URL counters.
14730
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014731capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14732 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14733 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14734 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14735
14736capture.req.method : string
14737 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14738 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14739 because it's allocated.
14740
14741capture.req.uri : string
14742 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14743 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14744 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14745 allocated.
14746
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014747capture.req.ver : string
14748 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14749 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14750 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14751
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014752capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14753 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14754 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14755 The first entry is an index of 0.
14756 See also: "capture response header"
14757
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014758capture.res.ver : string
14759 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14760 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14761 persistent flag.
14762
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014763req.body : binary
14764 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14765 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14766 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14767 the first chunk is analyzed.
14768
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014769req.body_param([<name>) : string
14770 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14771 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14772 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14773 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14774 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14775 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14776 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14777 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14778 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14779 given.
14780
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014781req.body_len : integer
14782 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14783 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14784 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14785 "option http-buffer-request".
14786
14787req.body_size : integer
14788 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14789 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14790 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14791 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14792 "option http-buffer-request".
14793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014794req.cook([<name>]) : string
14795cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14796 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14797 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14798 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14799 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14800 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14801 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14802 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14803 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14804
14805 ACL derivatives :
14806 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14807 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14808 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14809 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14810 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14811 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14812 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14813 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14816cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14817 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14818 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014820req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14821cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14822 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14823 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14824 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14825 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014827cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14828 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14829 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14830 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14831 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014832 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014833 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14834 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14835 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14836 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014838hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14839 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14840 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14841 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14842 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014843 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014845req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14846 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14847 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14848 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14849 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14850 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14851 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14852 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14853 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014855req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14856 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14857 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14858 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14859 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014861req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14862 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14863 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14864 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14865 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14866 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14867 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14868 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14869 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000014870 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014871 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14872 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014874 ACL derivatives :
14875 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14876 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14877 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14878 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14879 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14880 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14881 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14882 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14883
14884req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14885hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14886 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14887 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14888 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14889 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14890 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14891 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14892 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14893 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14894 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14895
14896req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14897hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14898 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14899 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14900 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14901 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14902 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14903 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14904 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14905 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14906
14907req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14908hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14909 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14910 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14911 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14912 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14913 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14914 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14915 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14916
14917http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14918 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14919 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14920 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14921 basic auth is supported.
14922
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014923http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14924 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14925 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14926 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14927 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014928 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14929 basic auth is supported.
14930
14931 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014932 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14933 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14934 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14935 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014936
14937http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014938 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14939 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014940 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14941 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014943method : integer + string
14944 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14945 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14946 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14947 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14948 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14949 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14950 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014952 ACL derivatives :
14953 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014955 Example :
14956 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14957 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14958 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014960path : string
14961 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14962 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14963 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14964 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14965 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14966 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14967 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014969 ACL derivatives :
14970 path : exact string match
14971 path_beg : prefix match
14972 path_dir : subdir match
14973 path_dom : domain match
14974 path_end : suffix match
14975 path_len : length match
14976 path_reg : regex match
14977 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014978
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014979query : string
14980 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14981 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14982 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14983 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014984 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014985 which stops before the question mark.
14986
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014987req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14988 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14989 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14990 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14991 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014993req.ver : string
14994req_ver : string (deprecated)
14995 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14996 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14997 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014999 ACL derivatives :
15000 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015002res.comp : boolean
15003 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15004 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15005 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015007res.comp_algo : string
15008 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15009 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15010 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015012res.cook([<name>]) : string
15013scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15014 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15015 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15016 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015018 ACL derivatives :
15019 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015021res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15022scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15023 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15024 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15025 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015027res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15028scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15029 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15030 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15031 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015033res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15034 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15035 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15036 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15037 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15038 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15039 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15040 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15041 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15042 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015044res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15045 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15046 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15047 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15048 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15049 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015051res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15052shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15053 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15054 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15055 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15056 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15057 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15058 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15059 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15060 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015062 ACL derivatives :
15063 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15064 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15065 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15066 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15067 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15068 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15069 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15070 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15071
15072res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15073shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15074 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15075 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15076 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15077 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15078 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015080res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15081shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15082 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15083 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15084 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15085 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15086 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15087 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015088
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015089res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15090 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15091 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15092 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15093 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015095res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15096shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15097 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15098 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15099 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15100 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15101 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15102 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104res.ver : string
15105resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15106 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15107 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015109 ACL derivatives :
15110 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015112set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15113 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15114 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015115 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015116 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015118 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15119 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015121status : integer
15122 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15123 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15124 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015125
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015126unique-id : string
15127 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15128 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15129 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15130 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15131 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15132 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015134url : string
15135 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15136 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15137 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15138 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15139 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15140 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15141 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015143 ACL derivatives :
15144 url : exact string match
15145 url_beg : prefix match
15146 url_dir : subdir match
15147 url_dom : domain match
15148 url_end : suffix match
15149 url_len : length match
15150 url_reg : regex match
15151 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015153url_ip : ip
15154 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15155 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15156 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15157 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15158 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15159 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15160 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015162url_port : integer
15163 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15164 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15165 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15166 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015167
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015168urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15169url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015170 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15171 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015172 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15173 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15174 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15175 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015176 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15177 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015178 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15179 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015181 ACL derivatives :
15182 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15183 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15184 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15185 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15186 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15187 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15188 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15189 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015190
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015192 Example :
15193 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15194 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15195 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15196 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015197
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015198urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015199 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15200 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15201 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015202
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015203url32 : integer
15204 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15205 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15206 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15207 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15208 is an unsigned integer.
15209
15210url32+src : binary
15211 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15212 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15213 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15214
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152167.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015217---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015219Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15220every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015221order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015223ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15224---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015225FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015226HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015227HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15228HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015229HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15230HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15231HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15232HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15233LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015234METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015235METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015236METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15237METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15238METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15239METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015240METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015241METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015242RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015243REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015244TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015245WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15246---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015247
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015248
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152498. Logging
15250----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015251
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015252One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15253provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15254very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15255provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15256state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015257to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015258headers.
15259
15260In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15261about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15262send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15263
15264 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15265 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15266 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15267 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15268 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015269 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
15270 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015271
15272The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15273allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15274as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15275while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15276real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15277delay.
15278
15279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152808.1. Log levels
15281---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015282
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015283TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015284source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015285HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15286in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15287track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15288syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15289about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015290
15291
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152928.2. Log formats
15293----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015294
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015295HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015296and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15297slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15298options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015299
15300 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15301 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15302 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15303 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15304 extents.
15305
15306 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15307 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15308 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15309 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15310 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15311
15312 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15313 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15314 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15315 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15316 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15317
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015318 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15319 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15320 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15321 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15322
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015323 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15324
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015325Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15326specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15327field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15328servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15329always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15330identifier.
15331
15332Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15333 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15334 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15335 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15336 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15337
15338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153398.2.1. Default log format
15340-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015341
15342This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15343as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15344format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15345
15346 Example :
15347 listen www
15348 mode http
15349 log global
15350 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15351
15352 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15353 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15354 (www/HTTP)
15355
15356 Field Format Extract from the example above
15357 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15358 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15359 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15360 4 'to' to
15361 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15362 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15363
15364Detailed fields description :
15365 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15366 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15367 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15368 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15369 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15370 and processed the connection.
15371 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15372
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015373In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15374"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15375connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15376
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015377It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15378will eventually disappear.
15379
15380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153818.2.2. TCP log format
15382---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015383
15384The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15385is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15386information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15387counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15388emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15389environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15390the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15391sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015392specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15393not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15394fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15395marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015396
15397 Example :
15398 frontend fnt
15399 mode tcp
15400 option tcplog
15401 log global
15402 default_backend bck
15403
15404 backend bck
15405 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15406
15407 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15408 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15409 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15410
15411 Field Format Extract from the example above
15412 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15413 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15414 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15415 4 frontend_name fnt
15416 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15417 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15418 7 bytes_read* 212
15419 8 termination_state --
15420 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15421 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15422
15423Detailed fields description :
15424 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015425 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15426 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15427 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015428 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15429 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15430 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015431
15432 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015433 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15434 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15435 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015436
15437 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15438 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15439 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15440 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15441
15442 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15443 and processed the connection.
15444
15445 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15446 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15447 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15448 applications.
15449
15450 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15451 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15452 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15453 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15454 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15455
15456 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15457 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15458 See "Timers" below for more details.
15459
15460 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15461 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15462 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15463 "Timers" below for more details.
15464
15465 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015466 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015467 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15468 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15469 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15470 details.
15471
15472 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15473 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15474 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15475 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15476 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15477
15478 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15479 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15480 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15481 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15482 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15483 for more details.
15484
15485 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015486 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015487 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15488 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15489 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015490 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015491
15492 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15493 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15494 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15495 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15496 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15497 caused by a denial of service attack.
15498
15499 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15500 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15501 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15502 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15503 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15504 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15505 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15506 denial of service attack.
15507
15508 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15509 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15510 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15511 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15512 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15513 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15514 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15515 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15516 be processed than on other servers.
15517
15518 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15519 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15520 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15521 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15522 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15523 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15524 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15525 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15526 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15527 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15528 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15529 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15530 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15531
15532 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15533 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15534 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15535 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15536 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15537 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15538 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15539 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15540
15541 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15542 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15543 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15544 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15545 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15546 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15547 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15548 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15549 occurs.
15550
15551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155528.2.3. HTTP log format
15553----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015554
15555The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15556is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15557the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15558are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15559emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15560generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15561"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15562which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015563frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15564is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015565
15566Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15567slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15568with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15569
15570 Example :
15571 frontend http-in
15572 mode http
15573 option httplog
15574 log global
15575 default_backend bck
15576
15577 backend static
15578 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15579
15580 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15581 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15582 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015583 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015584
15585 Field Format Extract from the example above
15586 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15587 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015588 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015589 4 frontend_name http-in
15590 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015591 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015592 7 status_code 200
15593 8 bytes_read* 2750
15594 9 captured_request_cookie -
15595 10 captured_response_cookie -
15596 11 termination_state ----
15597 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15598 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15599 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15600 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15601 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015602
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015603Detailed fields description :
15604 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015605 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15606 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15607 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015608 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15609 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15610 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015611
15612 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015613 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15614 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15615 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015616
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015617 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15618 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015619
15620 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15621 and processed the connection.
15622
15623 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15624 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15625 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15626
15627 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15628 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15629 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15630 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15631 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15632 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15633
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015634 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15635 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15636 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15637 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15638 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15639 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15640 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015641
15642 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15643 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15644 See "Timers" below for more details.
15645
15646 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15647 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15648 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15649 below for more details.
15650
15651 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15652 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15653 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15654 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15655 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15656 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15657 for more details.
15658
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015659 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15660 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15661 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15662 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15663 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15664 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15665 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15666 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015667
15668 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15669 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15670 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15671
15672 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15673 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15674 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15675 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15676 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15677 overflowing.
15678
15679 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15680 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15681 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15682 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15683 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15684 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15685 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15686 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15687
15688 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15689 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15690 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15691 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15692 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15693 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15694 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15695 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15696
15697 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15698 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15699 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15700 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15701 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15702 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15703 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15704
15705 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015706 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015707 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15708 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15709 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015710 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015711 system.
15712
15713 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15714 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15715 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15716 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15717 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15718 caused by a denial of service attack.
15719
15720 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15721 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15722 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15723 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15724 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15725 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15726 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15727 denial of service attack.
15728
15729 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15730 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15731 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15732 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15733 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15734 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15735 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15736 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15737 processed than on other servers.
15738
15739 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15740 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15741 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15742 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15743 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15744 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15745 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15746 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15747 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15748 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15749 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15750 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15751 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15752
15753 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15754 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15755 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15756 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15757 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15758 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15759 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15760 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15761
15762 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15763 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15764 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15765 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15766 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15767 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15768 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15769 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15770 occurs.
15771
15772 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15773 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15774 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15775 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15776 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15777 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15778 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15779 cookies" below for more details.
15780
15781 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15782 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15783 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15784 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15785 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15786 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15787 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15788 and cookies" below for more details.
15789
15790 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15791 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15792 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15793 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15794 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15795 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15796 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15797 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15798
15799
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200158008.2.4. Custom log format
15801------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015802
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015803The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015804mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015805
15806HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15807Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15808separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15809prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15810
15811Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15812variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015813("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015814
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015815If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015816as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015817less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15818the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15819
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015820Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015821In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015822in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015823
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015824Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15825'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15826https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15827such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15828
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015829Flags are :
15830 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015831 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015832 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15833 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015834
15835 Example:
15836
15837 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15838 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15839
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015840 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15841
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015842At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15843
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015844 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15845 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015846
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015847the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015848
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015849 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15850 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15851 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015852
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015853and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15854
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015855 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15856 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015857
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015858Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15859
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015860 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015861 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015862 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15863 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15864 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015865 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15866 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15867 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015868 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015869 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15870 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015871 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015872 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15873 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015874 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015875 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015876 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015877 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015878 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015879 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015880 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015881 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15882 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15883 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15884 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15885 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015886 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015887 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15888 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015889 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015890 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15891 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015892 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15893 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15894 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015895 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015896 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15897 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015898 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015899 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15900 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15901 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015902 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015903 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015904 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15905 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15906 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15907 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015908 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015909 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015910 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015911 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015912 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015913 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015914 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15915 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15916 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015917 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015918 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15919 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015920 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015921 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15922 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15923 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015924 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015925 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015926 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015927
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015928 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015929
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015930
159318.2.5. Error log format
15932-----------------------
15933
15934When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15935protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15936By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15937"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15938will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15939logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15940
15941The format looks like this :
15942
15943 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15944 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15945 Connection error during SSL handshake
15946
15947 Field Format Extract from the example above
15948 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15949 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15950 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15951 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15952 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15953
15954These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15955failures.
15956
15957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159588.3. Advanced logging options
15959-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015960
15961Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15962just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15963options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15964for more information about their usage.
15965
15966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159678.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15968------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015969
15970It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15971haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15972commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15973monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15974ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15975
15976 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15977 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15978 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15979 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15980
15981 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15982 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15983 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015984 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015985 such as other load-balancers.
15986
15987 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15988 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15989 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15990
15991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159928.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15993----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015994
15995The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15996what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15997or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15998"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15999just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16000log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16001after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16002is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16003with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16004with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16005
16006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16008------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016009
16010Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16011for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16012"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16013retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16014raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16015a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16016file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16017you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16018"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16019
16020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160218.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16022--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016023
16024Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16025multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16026them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16027"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16028logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16029error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16030and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16031too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16032useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16033alternative.
16034
16035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160368.4. Timing events
16037------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016038
16039Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16040reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16041the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16042frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016043mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16044addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16045
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016046Timings events in HTTP mode:
16047
16048 first request 2nd request
16049 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16050 t tr t tr ...
16051 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16052 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16053 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16054 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16055 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16056
16057Timings events in TCP mode:
16058
16059 TCP session
16060 |<----------------->|
16061 t t
16062 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16063 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16064 |<------ Tt ------->|
16065
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016066 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
16067 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
16068 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16069 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16070 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
16071 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
16072 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016073
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016074 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16075 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16076 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
16077 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
16078 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
16079 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
16080 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
16081 nothing was received on the connection.
16082
16083 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16084 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16085 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16086 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16087 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16088 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16089 request typed by hand during a test.
16090
16091 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16092 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
16093 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
16094 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16095 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16096 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16097 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016098
16099 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16100 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16101 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16102 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16103 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16104
16105 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16106 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16107 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16108 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16109 connection never established.
16110
16111 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16112 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16113 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16114 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16115 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16116 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16117 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16118 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16119 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16120 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16121 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16122
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016123 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16124 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16125 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16126 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16127 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16128 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16129
16130 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16131
16132 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16133 "Ta" can never be negative.
16134
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016135 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16136 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016137 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16138 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016139 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016140
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016141 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016142
16143 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016144 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16145 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016146
16147These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16148protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16149that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016150due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16151"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16152that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016153
16154Most common cases :
16155
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016156 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16157 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16158 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16159 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16160 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16161 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16162 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16163 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16164 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16165 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16166 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016167 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016168
16169 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16170 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16171 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16172 of ms on remote networks.
16173
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016174 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16175 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16176 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016177
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016178 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16179 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16180 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16181 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16182 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16183 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16184 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16185 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16186 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016187
16188Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16189
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016190 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016191 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016192 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016193
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016194 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016195 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16196 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16197
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016198 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016199 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16200 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16201 flags.
16202
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016203 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16204 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016205 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16206 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16207 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16208 the client connection was maintained open.
16209
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016210 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016211 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016212 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016213 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16214
16215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162168.5. Session state at disconnection
16217-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016218
16219TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16220"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
162212-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16222each of which has a special meaning :
16223
16224 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16225 session to terminate :
16226
16227 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16228
16229 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16230 server explicitly refused it.
16231
16232 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16233 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16234 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16235 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016236 (eg: cacheable cookie).
16237
16238 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16239 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016240
16241 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16242 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16243 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16244 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16245 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16246
16247 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16248 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16249 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16250 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16251 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16252
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016253 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16254 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16255
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016256 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16257 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16258 backup connections when going up.
16259
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016260 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16261
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016262 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16263 send or receive data.
16264
16265 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16266 send or receive data.
16267
16268 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16269 with nothing left in the buffers.
16270
16271 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16272
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016273 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016274 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16275
16276 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16277 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16278 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16279 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16280 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16281
16282 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16283 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16284
16285 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16286 server (HTTP only).
16287
16288 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16289
16290 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16291 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16292 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16293
16294 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16295 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16296 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16297
16298 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16299
16300 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16301 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16302
16303 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16304 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16305 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16306
16307 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16308 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016309 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16310 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016311
16312 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16313 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16314 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16315 another server.
16316
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016317 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016318 server.
16319
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016320 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16321 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16322 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16323 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16324
16325 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16326 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16327 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16328 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16329
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016330 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16331 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16332 "use-server" rule).
16333
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016334 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16335
16336 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16337 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16338
16339 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16340
16341 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16342 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16343 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16344
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016345 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16346 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016347 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016348 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16349 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16350
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016351 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16352
16353 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16354 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16355
16356 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16357
16358 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16359
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016360The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16361was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016362helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16363starvation, attacks, etc...
16364
16365The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16366alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16367easier finding and understanding.
16368
16369 Flags Reason
16370
16371 -- Normal termination.
16372
16373 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16374 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16375 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16376 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16377
16378 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16379 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16380 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16381 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16382 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16383 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016384
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016385 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16386 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016387 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016388
16389 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16390 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16391 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16392
16393 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16394 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16395 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16396 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16397 the server takes too long to respond.
16398
16399 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16400 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16401 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16402 long a time to respond.
16403
16404 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16405 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16406 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16407 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016408 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16409 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016410
16411 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16412 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16413 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16414 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16415 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016416 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016417 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16418 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16419 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16420 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16421 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16422 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16423 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16424 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16425 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16426 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16427 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16428 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016429
16430 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16431 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016432 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16433 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16434 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16435 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016436
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016437 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16438 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16439
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016440 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016441 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16442 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16443 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16444 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16445 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16446
16447 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16448 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16449 503 or 504 here.
16450
16451 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16452 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16453 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16454 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16455 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16456
16457 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16458 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016459 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016460 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16461 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16462
16463 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16464 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16465 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16466 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16467 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16468 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16469 between haproxy and the server.
16470
16471 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16472 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16473 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16474 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16475 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16476 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16477 solution is to fix the application.
16478
16479 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16480 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16481 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16482 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16483 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16484 external attacks.
16485
16486 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16487 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016488 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016489 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16490 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16491
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016492 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16493 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16494 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016495 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16496 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016497
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016498 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16499 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16500 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16501 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016502 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16503 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16504 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16505 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16506 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016507
16508 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16509 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16510 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16511 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16512
16513 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16514 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16515 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16516 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16517
16518 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16519 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16520 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16521 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16522
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016523The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16524persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16525important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16526re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16527
16528 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16529
16530 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16531 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16532 set on a GET request.
16533
16534 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16535 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016536 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016537 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16538
16539 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16540 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16541 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16542
16543 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16544 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16545 already got a cookie.
16546
16547 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16548 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16549 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16550 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16551 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16552
16553 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16554 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16555 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16556
16557 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16558 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16559 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16560
16561 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16562 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16563
16564 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16565 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16566 then advertised in the response.
16567
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165698.6. Non-printable characters
16570-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016571
16572In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16573consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16574converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16575prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16576being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16577escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16578is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16579'}' when logging headers.
16580
16581Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16582issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16583containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16584
16585Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16586the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16587performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16588
16589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16591---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016592
16593Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16594achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016595section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016596cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16597the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16598the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016599locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016600not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16601user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16602a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16603wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16604
16605 Examples :
16606 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16607 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16608
16609 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16610 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16611
16612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16614---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016615
16616Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16617proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16618the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16619server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16620
16621Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16622response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016623section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016624
16625It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016626time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16627appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016628are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16629and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16630follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16631request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16632in the logs.
16633
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016634As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16635frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16636an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16637
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016638 Example :
16639 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16640 listen proxy-out
16641 mode http
16642 option httplog
16643 option logasap
16644 log global
16645 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16646
16647 # log the name of the virtual server
16648 capture request header Host len 20
16649
16650 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16651 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16652
16653 # log the beginning of the referrer
16654 capture request header Referer len 20
16655
16656 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16657 capture response header Server len 20
16658
16659 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16660 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16661
16662 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16663 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16664
16665 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16666 capture response header Via len 20
16667
16668 # log the URL location during a redirection
16669 capture response header Location len 20
16670
16671 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16672 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16673 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16674 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16675 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16676
16677 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16678 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16679 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16680 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016681 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016682
16683 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16684 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16685 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16686 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16687 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016688 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016689
16690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166918.9. Examples of logs
16692---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016693
16694These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16695them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16696reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16697
16698 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16699 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16700 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16701
16702 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16703 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16704
16705 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16706 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16707 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16708
16709 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16710 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16711
16712 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16713 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16714 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16715
16716 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016717 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016718 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16719 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16720
16721 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16722 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16723 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16724
16725 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16726 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016727 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016728 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16729 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16730 to return the 502 and not the server.
16731
16732 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016733 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016734
16735 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16736 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16737 Nothing was sent to any server.
16738
16739 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16740 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16741
16742 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16743 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16744 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16745 send a 408 return code to the client.
16746
16747 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16748 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16749
16750 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16751 5 seconds ("c----").
16752
16753 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16754 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016755 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016756
16757 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016758 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016759 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16760 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16761 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16762 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16763 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016764
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016765
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200167669. Supported filters
16767--------------------
16768
16769Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16770accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16771unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16772
16773See also : "filter"
16774
167759.1. Trace
16776----------
16777
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016778filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016779
16780 Arguments:
16781 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16782 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16783
16784 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16785 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16786 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16787 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16788
16789 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16790 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16791 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16792 amount of the parsed data.
16793
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016794 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16795
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016796This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16797callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16798information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16799filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16800
16801Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16802tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16803a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16804
16805
168069.2. HTTP compression
16807---------------------
16808
16809filter compression
16810
16811The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16812keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16813when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16814use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16815used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16816filters evaluation order.
16817
16818See also : "compression"
16819
16820
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200168219.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16822--------------------------------------------
16823
16824filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16825
16826 Arguments :
16827
16828 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16829 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16830 parsed.
16831
16832 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16833 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16834 part must be placed in its own scope.
16835
16836The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16837external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16838streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16839exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16840also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16841
16842SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16843the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16844
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016845For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016846"doc/SPOE.txt".
16847
16848Important note:
16849 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16850 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16851
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016852/*
16853 * Local variables:
16854 * fill-column: 79
16855 * End:
16856 */